bfd/
[binutils.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
blob27d2dc3854bb3d7bc15dc0df1bdf9db77f2f4a5e
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6 <ian@cygnus.com>.
7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8 <mark@codesourcery.com>
9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
17 (at your option) any later version.
19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
22 GNU General Public License for more details.
24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "sysdep.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "libiberty.h"
34 #include "elf-bfd.h"
35 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
36 #include "elf/mips.h"
38 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
39 #include "coff/sym.h"
40 #include "coff/symconst.h"
41 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
42 #include "coff/mips.h"
44 #include "hashtab.h"
46 /* This structure is used to hold .got entries while estimating got
47 sizes. */
48 struct mips_got_entry
50 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
51 bfd *abfd;
52 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
53 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
54 long symndx;
55 union
57 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
58 bfd_vma address;
59 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
60 that should be added to the symbol value. */
61 bfd_vma addend;
62 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
63 corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
64 h->forced_local). */
65 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
66 } d;
68 /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
69 IE). The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
70 relocations. LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
71 combined with any GD or IE flags. An LDM GOT entry will be
72 a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
73 unsigned char tls_type;
75 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
76 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
77 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
78 long gotidx;
81 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
83 struct mips_got_info
85 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
86 symbol table. */
87 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
88 /* The number of global .got entries. */
89 unsigned int global_gotno;
90 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
91 unsigned int tls_gotno;
92 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
93 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
94 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
95 /* The number of local .got entries. */
96 unsigned int local_gotno;
97 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
98 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
99 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
100 struct htab *got_entries;
101 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
102 unless multi-got was necessary. */
103 struct htab *bfd2got;
104 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
105 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
106 struct mips_got_info *next;
107 /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
108 for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned. This is needed
109 because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
110 for the LDM. It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode. */
111 bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
114 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
116 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
117 bfd *bfd;
118 struct mips_got_info *g;
121 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
122 create and merge bfd's gots. */
124 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
126 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
127 htab_t bfd2got;
128 /* The output bfd. */
129 bfd *obfd;
130 /* The link information. */
131 struct bfd_link_info *info;
132 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
133 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
134 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
135 struct mips_got_info *primary;
136 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
137 gots. */
138 struct mips_got_info *current;
139 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
140 16-bit offset. */
141 unsigned int max_count;
142 /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got. */
143 unsigned int primary_count;
144 /* The number of local and global entries in the current got. */
145 unsigned int current_count;
146 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
147 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
148 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
149 the "master" GOT. */
150 unsigned int global_count;
153 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
155 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
157 struct mips_got_info *g;
158 int value;
159 unsigned int needed_relocs;
160 struct bfd_link_info *info;
163 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
164 entry or ELF symbol table traversal. */
166 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
168 struct bfd_link_info *info;
169 unsigned int needed;
172 struct _mips_elf_section_data
174 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
175 union
177 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
178 bfd_byte *tdata;
179 } u;
182 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
183 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
185 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
186 the dynamic symbols. */
188 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
190 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
191 index. */
192 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
193 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
194 symbol with a GOT entry. */
195 long min_got_dynindx;
196 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
197 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
198 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
199 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
200 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
201 symbol without a GOT entry. */
202 long max_non_got_dynindx;
205 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
206 the global hash table. */
208 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
210 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
212 /* External symbol information. */
213 EXTR esym;
215 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
216 this symbol. */
217 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
219 /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
220 a readonly section. */
221 bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
223 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
224 related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
225 R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
226 p. 4-20. */
227 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
229 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
230 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
231 asection *fn_stub;
233 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
234 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
235 bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
237 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
238 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
239 asection *call_stub;
241 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
242 being called returns a floating point value. */
243 asection *call_fp_stub;
245 /* Are we forced local? This will only be set if we have converted
246 the initial global GOT entry to a local GOT entry. */
247 bfd_boolean forced_local;
249 #define GOT_NORMAL 0
250 #define GOT_TLS_GD 1
251 #define GOT_TLS_LDM 2
252 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4
253 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE 0x40
254 #define GOT_TLS_DONE 0x80
255 unsigned char tls_type;
256 /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
257 is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
258 there. In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
259 structures all referring to the same GOT slot. It might be
260 possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
261 overloaded already. */
262 bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
265 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
267 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
269 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
270 #if 0
271 /* We no longer use this. */
272 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
273 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
274 #endif
275 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
276 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
277 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
278 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
279 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
280 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
281 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
282 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
283 bfd_vma rld_value;
284 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
285 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
288 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
289 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
290 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
291 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
292 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
293 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
294 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
295 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
296 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
297 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
298 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
299 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
300 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
301 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
303 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
305 struct extsym_info
307 bfd *abfd;
308 struct bfd_link_info *info;
309 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
310 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
311 bfd_boolean failed;
314 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
316 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
318 "_procedure_table",
319 "_procedure_string_table",
320 "_procedure_table_size",
321 NULL
324 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
325 IRIX5. */
327 typedef struct
329 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
330 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
331 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
332 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
333 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
334 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
335 } Elf32_compact_rel;
337 typedef struct
339 bfd_byte id1[4];
340 bfd_byte num[4];
341 bfd_byte id2[4];
342 bfd_byte offset[4];
343 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
344 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
345 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
347 typedef struct
349 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
350 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
351 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
352 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
353 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
354 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
355 } Elf32_crinfo;
357 typedef struct
359 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
360 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
361 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
362 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
363 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
364 } Elf32_crinfo2;
366 typedef struct
368 bfd_byte info[4];
369 bfd_byte konst[4];
370 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
371 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
373 typedef struct
375 bfd_byte info[4];
376 bfd_byte konst[4];
377 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
379 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
381 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
382 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
383 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
384 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
385 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
386 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
387 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
388 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
390 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
391 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
392 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
393 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
394 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
396 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
397 has different meaning for each type:
399 (type) (konst)
400 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
401 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
402 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
403 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
406 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
407 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
408 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
409 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
411 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
412 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
413 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
414 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
416 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
417 loader for use by the static exception system. */
419 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
420 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
421 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
422 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
423 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
424 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
425 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
426 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
427 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
428 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
429 long reserved;
430 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
431 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
432 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
433 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
435 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
436 (bfd *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *, bfd_vma, unsigned long,
437 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
438 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
439 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
440 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
441 (bfd_vma);
442 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_stub_section_p
443 (bfd *, asection *);
444 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
445 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
446 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
447 bfd_vma *, asection *);
448 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
449 (const void *);
450 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
451 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
452 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
453 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
455 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
456 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
458 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
460 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
461 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
463 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
464 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
465 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
467 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
468 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
470 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
471 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
472 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
474 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
475 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
476 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
478 /* The name of the options section. */
479 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
480 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
482 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
483 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
484 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
485 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
487 /* The name of the stub section. */
488 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
490 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
491 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
492 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
494 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
495 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
496 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
498 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
499 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
500 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
502 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
503 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
504 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
506 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
507 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
508 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
510 /* Get word-sized data. */
511 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
512 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
514 /* Put out word-sized data. */
515 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
516 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
517 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
518 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
520 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
521 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
522 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
524 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
525 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
527 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
528 (zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are
529 two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
530 the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is
531 in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
532 relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if
533 rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
534 section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
535 section, that is RELA. */
536 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \
537 ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \
538 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \
539 > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \
540 == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \
541 == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \
542 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
544 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
545 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
546 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
547 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
549 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */
550 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (2)
552 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
553 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) (0x7ff0)
555 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
556 offsets from $gp. */
557 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(abfd) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) + 0x7fff)
559 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
560 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
561 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
562 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
563 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
564 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
565 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
566 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
567 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
568 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
569 #define STUB_LI16(abfd) \
570 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
571 ? 0x64180000 /* daddiu t8,zero,0 */ \
572 : 0x24180000)) /* addiu t8,zero,0 */
573 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE (16)
575 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
576 section. */
578 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
579 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
580 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
581 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
583 #ifdef BFD64
584 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
585 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
586 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
587 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
588 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
589 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
590 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
591 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
592 #else
593 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
594 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
595 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
596 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
597 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
598 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
599 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
600 #endif
602 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
603 floating point arguments.
605 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
606 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
607 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
608 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
609 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
610 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
611 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
612 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
614 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
615 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
616 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
617 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
618 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
619 stub should be discarded.
621 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
622 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
623 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
624 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
625 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
626 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
627 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
628 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
630 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
631 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
632 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
634 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
636 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
637 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
638 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
640 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
642 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
643 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
644 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
645 (copy), (follow)))
647 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
649 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
650 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
651 (&(table)->root, \
652 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
653 (info)))
655 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
657 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
658 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
660 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
661 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
663 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
664 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
666 static bfd_vma
667 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
669 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
670 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
671 return 0;
672 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
675 static bfd_vma
676 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
678 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
679 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
680 return 0;
681 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
684 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
686 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
687 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
688 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
690 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
691 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
693 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
694 subclass. */
695 if (ret == NULL)
696 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
697 if (ret == NULL)
698 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
700 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
701 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
702 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
703 table, string));
704 if (ret != NULL)
706 /* Set local fields. */
707 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
708 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
709 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
710 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
711 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
712 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
713 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
714 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
715 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
716 ret->call_stub = NULL;
717 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
718 ret->forced_local = FALSE;
719 ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
722 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
725 bfd_boolean
726 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
728 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
729 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
731 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
732 if (sdata == NULL)
733 return FALSE;
734 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
736 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
739 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
740 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
742 bfd_boolean
743 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
744 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
746 HDRR *symhdr;
747 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
748 char *ext_hdr;
750 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
751 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
753 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
754 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
755 goto error_return;
757 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
758 swap->external_hdr_size))
759 goto error_return;
761 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
762 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
764 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
765 read. */
766 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
767 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
768 debug->ptr = NULL; \
769 else \
771 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
772 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
773 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
774 goto error_return; \
775 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
776 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
777 goto error_return; \
780 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
781 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
782 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
783 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
784 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
785 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
786 union aux_ext *);
787 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
788 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
789 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
790 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
791 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
792 #undef READ
794 debug->fdr = NULL;
796 return TRUE;
798 error_return:
799 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
800 free (ext_hdr);
801 if (debug->line != NULL)
802 free (debug->line);
803 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
804 free (debug->external_dnr);
805 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
806 free (debug->external_pdr);
807 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
808 free (debug->external_sym);
809 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
810 free (debug->external_opt);
811 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
812 free (debug->external_aux);
813 if (debug->ss != NULL)
814 free (debug->ss);
815 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
816 free (debug->ssext);
817 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
818 free (debug->external_fdr);
819 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
820 free (debug->external_rfd);
821 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
822 free (debug->external_ext);
823 return FALSE;
826 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
828 static void
829 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
831 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
832 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
833 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
834 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
835 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
836 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
838 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
839 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
841 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
844 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
846 static bfd_boolean
847 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
848 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
849 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
851 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
852 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
853 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
854 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
855 void *rtproc;
856 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
857 struct sym_ext *esym;
858 char *ss, **sv;
859 char *str;
860 bfd_size_type size;
861 bfd_size_type count;
862 unsigned long sindex;
863 unsigned long i;
864 PDR pdr;
865 SYMR sym;
866 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
868 epdr = NULL;
869 rpdr = NULL;
870 esym = NULL;
871 ss = NULL;
872 sv = NULL;
874 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
876 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
877 count = hdr->ipdMax;
878 if (count > 0)
880 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
882 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
883 if (epdr == NULL)
884 goto error_return;
886 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
887 goto error_return;
889 size = sizeof (RPDR);
890 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
891 if (rpdr == NULL)
892 goto error_return;
894 size = sizeof (char *);
895 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
896 if (sv == NULL)
897 goto error_return;
899 count = hdr->isymMax;
900 size = swap->external_sym_size;
901 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
902 if (esym == NULL)
903 goto error_return;
905 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
906 goto error_return;
908 count = hdr->issMax;
909 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
910 if (ss == NULL)
911 goto error_return;
912 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
913 goto error_return;
915 count = hdr->ipdMax;
916 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
918 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
919 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
920 rp->adr = sym.value;
921 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
922 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
923 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
924 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
925 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
926 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
927 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
928 rp->irpss = sindex;
929 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
930 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
934 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
935 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
936 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
937 if (rtproc == NULL)
939 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
940 goto error_return;
943 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
945 erp = rtproc;
946 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
947 erp++;
948 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
949 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
950 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
951 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
953 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
954 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
955 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
957 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
959 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
960 s->size = size;
961 s->contents = rtproc;
963 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
964 matters, but someday it might). */
965 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
967 if (epdr != NULL)
968 free (epdr);
969 if (rpdr != NULL)
970 free (rpdr);
971 if (esym != NULL)
972 free (esym);
973 if (ss != NULL)
974 free (ss);
975 if (sv != NULL)
976 free (sv);
978 return TRUE;
980 error_return:
981 if (epdr != NULL)
982 free (epdr);
983 if (rpdr != NULL)
984 free (rpdr);
985 if (esym != NULL)
986 free (esym);
987 if (ss != NULL)
988 free (ss);
989 if (sv != NULL)
990 free (sv);
991 return FALSE;
994 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
995 discard them. */
997 static bfd_boolean
998 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
999 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1001 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1002 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1004 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1005 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1007 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1008 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1009 being included in the link. */
1010 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1011 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1012 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1013 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1016 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1017 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1019 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1020 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1021 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1022 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1023 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1024 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1025 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1028 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1029 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1031 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1032 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1033 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1034 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1035 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1036 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1037 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1040 return TRUE;
1043 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1044 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1045 are 32 bits.
1047 The format of these instructions is:
1049 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1050 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
1051 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1052 | Immediate 15:0 |
1053 +-----------------------------------------------+
1055 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1056 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1058 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1059 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
1060 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1061 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1062 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1063 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1064 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
1065 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1066 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1067 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1068 instruction.
1070 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1071 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
1072 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
1073 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1074 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1075 value as two 16-bit values.
1077 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1078 defined as
1080 big-endian:
1081 +--------+----------------------+
1082 | | |
1083 | | targ26-16 |
1084 |31 26|25 0|
1085 +--------+----------------------+
1087 little-endian:
1088 +----------+------+-------------+
1089 | | | |
1090 | sub1 | | sub2 |
1091 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
1092 +----------+--------------------+
1093 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1094 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1096 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1097 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1098 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1099 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1100 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1102 R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
1103 mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1105 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1106 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
1107 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1108 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
1109 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1111 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
1112 opcode.
1114 This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
1115 addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
1116 is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
1118 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As
1119 above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1120 little-endian system.
1122 R_MIPS16_HI16 and R_MIPS16_LO16 are used in mips16 mode to
1123 access data when neither GP-relative nor PC-relative addressing
1124 can be used. They are handled like R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16,
1125 except that the addend is retrieved and stored as shown above
1126 for R_MIPS16_GPREL.
1128 void
1129 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1130 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1132 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1134 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1135 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1136 return;
1138 /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction. */
1139 extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1140 insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1141 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1143 if (jal_shuffle)
1144 val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1145 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1146 else
1147 val = extend << 16 | insn;
1149 else
1150 val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1151 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1152 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1155 void
1156 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1157 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1159 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1161 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1162 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1163 return;
1165 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1166 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1168 if (jal_shuffle)
1170 insn = val & 0xffff;
1171 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1172 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1174 else
1176 insn = val & 0xffff;
1177 extend = val >> 16;
1180 else
1182 insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1183 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1185 bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1186 bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1189 bfd_reloc_status_type
1190 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1191 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1192 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1194 bfd_vma relocation;
1195 bfd_signed_vma val;
1196 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1198 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1199 relocation = 0;
1200 else
1201 relocation = symbol->value;
1203 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1204 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1206 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1207 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1209 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
1210 val = reloc_entry->addend;
1212 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1214 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
1215 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1216 an external symbol. */
1217 if (! relocatable
1218 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1219 val += relocation - gp;
1221 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1223 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1224 (bfd_byte *) data
1225 + reloc_entry->address);
1226 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1227 return status;
1229 else
1230 reloc_entry->addend = val;
1232 if (relocatable)
1233 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1235 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1238 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1239 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1240 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1241 INPUT_SECTION. */
1243 struct mips_hi16
1245 struct mips_hi16 *next;
1246 bfd_byte *data;
1247 asection *input_section;
1248 arelent rel;
1251 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
1253 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1255 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
1256 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1257 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1259 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1260 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1261 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
1262 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
1264 bfd_reloc_status_type
1265 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1266 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1267 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1268 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1270 struct mips_hi16 *n;
1272 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1273 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1275 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1276 if (n == NULL)
1277 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1279 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1280 n->data = data;
1281 n->input_section = input_section;
1282 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1283 mips_hi16_list = n;
1285 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1286 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1288 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1291 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just
1292 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1293 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
1295 bfd_reloc_status_type
1296 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1297 void *data, asection *input_section,
1298 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1300 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1301 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1302 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1303 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
1304 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1305 input_section, output_bfd,
1306 error_message);
1308 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1309 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1312 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
1313 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1314 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
1316 bfd_reloc_status_type
1317 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1318 void *data, asection *input_section,
1319 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1321 bfd_vma vallo;
1322 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1324 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1325 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1327 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1328 location);
1329 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
1330 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1331 location);
1333 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1335 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1336 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1338 hi = mips_hi16_list;
1340 /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
1341 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1342 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
1343 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1344 has a rightshift of 0. */
1345 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1346 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1348 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1349 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
1350 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1352 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1353 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1354 error_message);
1355 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1356 return ret;
1358 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1359 free (hi);
1362 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1363 input_section, output_bfd,
1364 error_message);
1367 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
1368 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1369 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
1371 bfd_reloc_status_type
1372 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1373 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1374 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1375 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1377 bfd_signed_vma val;
1378 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1379 bfd_boolean relocatable;
1381 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1383 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1384 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1386 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
1387 val = 0;
1388 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1390 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1391 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
1392 offset or address. */
1393 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1394 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1397 if (!relocatable)
1399 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
1400 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
1401 val += symbol->value;
1402 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1404 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1405 val -= input_section->output_offset;
1406 val -= reloc_entry->address;
1410 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
1411 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1412 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
1413 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
1414 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1415 reloc_entry->addend += val;
1416 else
1418 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1420 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
1421 val += reloc_entry->addend;
1423 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
1424 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1425 location);
1426 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1427 location);
1428 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1429 location);
1431 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1432 return status;
1435 if (relocatable)
1436 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1438 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1441 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
1442 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
1444 static void
1445 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1446 Elf32_gptab *in)
1448 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1449 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1452 static void
1453 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1454 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1456 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1457 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1460 static void
1461 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1462 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1464 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1465 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1466 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1467 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1468 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1469 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1472 static void
1473 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1474 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1476 unsigned long l;
1478 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1479 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1480 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1481 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1482 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1483 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1484 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1487 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
1488 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
1489 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
1491 void
1492 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1493 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1495 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1496 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1497 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1498 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1499 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1500 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1503 void
1504 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1505 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1507 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1508 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1509 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1510 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1511 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1512 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1515 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1516 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
1517 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
1518 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
1519 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
1521 void
1522 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1523 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1525 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1526 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1527 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1528 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1529 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1530 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1531 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1534 void
1535 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1536 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1538 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1539 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1540 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1541 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1542 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1543 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1544 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1547 /* Swap in an options header. */
1549 void
1550 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1551 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1553 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1554 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1555 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1556 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1559 /* Swap out an options header. */
1561 void
1562 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1563 Elf_External_Options *ex)
1565 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1566 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1567 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1568 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1571 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1572 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
1574 static int
1575 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1577 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1578 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1580 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1581 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1583 return ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1586 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
1588 static int
1589 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1590 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1592 #ifdef BFD64
1593 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1594 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1596 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1597 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1598 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1599 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1601 return (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info)
1602 - ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info));
1603 #else
1604 abort ();
1605 #endif
1609 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1610 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
1611 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1612 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1613 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1614 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
1615 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1616 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1617 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1618 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1619 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1620 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
1621 when generating a final executable. */
1623 static bfd_boolean
1624 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1626 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1627 bfd_boolean strip;
1628 asection *sec, *output_section;
1630 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1631 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1633 if (h->root.indx == -2)
1634 strip = FALSE;
1635 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
1636 || h->root.ref_dynamic
1637 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
1638 && !h->root.def_regular
1639 && !h->root.ref_regular)
1640 strip = TRUE;
1641 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1642 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1643 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1644 h->root.root.root.string,
1645 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1646 strip = TRUE;
1647 else
1648 strip = FALSE;
1650 if (strip)
1651 return TRUE;
1653 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1655 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1656 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1657 h->esym.weakext = 0;
1658 h->esym.reserved = 0;
1659 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1660 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1661 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1663 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1664 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1666 const char *name;
1668 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
1669 special symbols. */
1670 name = h->root.root.root.string;
1671 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1672 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1674 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1675 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1676 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1678 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1680 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1681 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1682 h->esym.asym.value =
1683 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1685 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1687 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1688 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1689 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1691 else
1692 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1694 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1695 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1696 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1697 else
1699 const char *name;
1701 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1702 output_section = sec->output_section;
1704 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1705 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
1706 if (output_section == NULL)
1707 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1708 else
1710 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1712 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1713 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1714 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1715 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1716 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1717 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1718 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1719 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1720 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1721 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1722 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1723 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1724 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1725 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1726 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1727 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1728 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1729 else
1730 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1734 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1735 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1738 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1739 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1740 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1741 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1743 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1744 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1745 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1746 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1748 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1749 output_section = sec->output_section;
1750 if (output_section != NULL)
1751 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1752 + sec->output_offset
1753 + output_section->vma);
1754 else
1755 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1757 else if (h->root.needs_plt)
1759 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1760 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1762 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1764 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1765 no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1768 if (!no_fn_stub)
1770 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
1771 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1772 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1773 if (sec == NULL)
1774 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1775 else
1777 output_section = sec->output_section;
1778 if (output_section != NULL)
1779 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1780 + sec->output_offset
1781 + output_section->vma);
1782 else
1783 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1788 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1789 h->root.root.root.string,
1790 &h->esym))
1792 einfo->failed = TRUE;
1793 return FALSE;
1796 return TRUE;
1799 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
1801 static int
1802 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1804 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1805 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1807 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1810 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
1812 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1813 hash number. */
1815 static INLINE hashval_t
1816 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1818 #ifdef BFD64
1819 return addr + (addr >> 32);
1820 #else
1821 return addr;
1822 #endif
1825 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
1826 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
1827 union members. */
1829 static hashval_t
1830 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1832 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1834 return entry->symndx
1835 + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
1836 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1837 : entry->abfd->id
1838 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
1839 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
1842 static int
1843 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1845 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1846 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1848 /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry. */
1849 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1850 return 0;
1852 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1853 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1854 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1855 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1858 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
1859 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
1860 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
1861 accordingly. */
1863 static hashval_t
1864 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1866 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1868 return entry->symndx
1869 + (! entry->abfd
1870 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1871 : entry->symndx >= 0
1872 ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1873 ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
1874 : (entry->abfd->id
1875 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
1876 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
1879 static int
1880 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1882 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1883 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1885 /* Any two LDM entries match. */
1886 if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1887 return 1;
1889 /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry. */
1890 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1891 return 0;
1893 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1894 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1895 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
1896 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1897 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1900 /* Returns the dynamic relocation section for DYNOBJ. */
1902 static asection *
1903 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (bfd *dynobj, bfd_boolean create_p)
1905 static const char dname[] = ".rel.dyn";
1906 asection *sreloc;
1908 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
1909 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
1911 sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
1912 (SEC_ALLOC
1913 | SEC_LOAD
1914 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
1915 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1916 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
1917 | SEC_READONLY));
1918 if (sreloc == NULL
1919 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
1920 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
1921 return NULL;
1923 return sreloc;
1926 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */
1928 static asection *
1929 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
1931 asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1932 if (sgot == NULL
1933 || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
1934 return NULL;
1935 return sgot;
1938 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
1939 INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
1940 section. */
1942 static struct mips_got_info *
1943 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
1945 asection *sgot;
1946 struct mips_got_info *g;
1948 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
1949 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
1950 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
1951 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
1952 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
1954 if (sgotp)
1955 *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
1957 return g;
1960 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
1961 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
1962 is NULL). */
1964 static int
1965 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
1966 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1968 int indx = 0;
1969 int ret = 0;
1970 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
1971 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
1973 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
1974 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
1975 indx = h->dynindx;
1977 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
1978 && (h == NULL
1979 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
1980 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
1981 need_relocs = TRUE;
1983 if (!need_relocs)
1984 return FALSE;
1986 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
1988 ret++;
1989 if (indx != 0)
1990 ret++;
1993 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
1994 ret++;
1996 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
1997 ret++;
1999 return ret;
2002 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2003 ARG1, if it describes a local symbol. */
2005 static int
2006 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2008 struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2009 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2011 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2012 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2014 return 1;
2017 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2018 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2020 static int
2021 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2023 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2024 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2025 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2027 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2028 arg->needed += 2;
2029 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2030 arg->needed += 1;
2032 return 1;
2035 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2036 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2038 static int
2039 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2041 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2042 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2043 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2045 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2047 return 1;
2050 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
2052 static void
2053 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2054 asection *sreloc,
2055 unsigned long indx,
2056 int r_type,
2057 bfd_vma offset)
2059 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2061 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2063 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2064 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2066 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2068 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2069 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2070 (sreloc->contents
2071 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2073 else
2074 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2075 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2076 (sreloc->contents
2077 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2078 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
2081 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
2083 static void
2084 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2085 unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2086 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2087 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2088 bfd_vma value)
2090 int indx;
2091 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2092 bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2093 bfd *dynobj;
2094 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2096 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2097 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2099 indx = 0;
2100 if (h != NULL)
2102 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2104 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2105 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2106 indx = h->root.dynindx;
2109 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2110 return;
2112 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2113 && (h == NULL
2114 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2115 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2116 need_relocs = TRUE;
2118 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
2119 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2120 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
2121 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2122 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2124 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
2125 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2127 /* General Dynamic. */
2128 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2130 offset = got_offset;
2131 offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2133 if (need_relocs)
2135 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2136 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2137 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2138 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2140 if (indx)
2141 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2142 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2143 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2144 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2145 else
2146 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2147 sgot->contents + offset2);
2149 else
2151 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2152 sgot->contents + offset);
2153 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2154 sgot->contents + offset2);
2157 got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2160 /* Initial Exec model. */
2161 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2163 offset = got_offset;
2165 if (need_relocs)
2167 if (indx == 0)
2168 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2169 sgot->contents + offset);
2170 else
2171 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2172 sgot->contents + offset);
2174 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2175 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2176 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2177 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2179 else
2180 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2181 sgot->contents + offset);
2184 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2186 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2187 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
2188 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2189 sgot->contents + got_offset
2190 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2192 if (!info->shared)
2193 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2194 sgot->contents + got_offset);
2195 else
2196 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2197 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2198 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2199 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2202 *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2205 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2206 a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models. The GOT entries for this
2207 symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX. This function initializes the
2208 GOT entries and corresponding relocations. */
2210 static bfd_vma
2211 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2212 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2213 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2215 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2216 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2218 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2220 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2222 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2223 if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2224 return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2225 else
2226 return got_index;
2229 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2231 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2232 return got_index;
2235 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2237 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
2238 return got_index;
2241 return got_index;
2244 /* Returns the GOT offset at which the indicated address can be found.
2245 If there is not yet a GOT entry for this value, create one. If
2246 R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS GOT entry instead.
2247 Returns -1 if no satisfactory GOT offset can be found. */
2249 static bfd_vma
2250 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2251 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
2252 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
2254 asection *sgot;
2255 struct mips_got_info *g;
2256 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2258 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2260 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value,
2261 r_symndx, h, r_type);
2262 if (!entry)
2263 return MINUS_ONE;
2265 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2266 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type, r_type,
2267 info, h, value);
2268 else
2269 return entry->gotidx;
2272 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
2274 static bfd_vma
2275 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2276 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2278 bfd_vma index;
2279 asection *sgot;
2280 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
2281 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
2283 gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
2284 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
2286 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
2288 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
2290 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2291 if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2293 e.abfd = ibfd;
2294 e.symndx = -1;
2295 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
2296 e.tls_type = 0;
2298 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
2300 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
2302 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2304 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2305 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2306 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2307 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2308 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2309 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2310 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2312 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
2313 info, e.d.h, value);
2315 else
2316 return p->gotidx;
2320 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
2321 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
2323 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2325 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2326 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2327 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2329 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2330 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2331 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2332 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2333 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2334 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2336 index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
2337 r_type, info, hm, value);
2339 else
2341 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
2342 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
2343 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
2344 offset. */
2345 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
2346 index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
2347 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2349 BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->size);
2351 return index;
2354 /* Find a GOT entry that is within 32KB of the VALUE. These entries
2355 are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
2356 within 32KB of GP. Return the index into the GOT for this page,
2357 and store the offset from this entry to the desired address in
2358 OFFSETP, if it is non-NULL. */
2360 static bfd_vma
2361 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2362 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
2364 asection *sgot;
2365 struct mips_got_info *g;
2366 bfd_vma index;
2367 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2369 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2371 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot,
2372 (value + 0x8000)
2373 & (~(bfd_vma)0xffff), 0,
2374 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
2376 if (!entry)
2377 return MINUS_ONE;
2379 index = entry->gotidx;
2381 if (offsetp)
2382 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
2384 return index;
2387 /* Find a GOT entry whose higher-order 16 bits are the same as those
2388 for value. Return the index into the GOT for this entry. */
2390 static bfd_vma
2391 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2392 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
2394 asection *sgot;
2395 struct mips_got_info *g;
2396 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2398 if (! external)
2400 /* Although the ABI says that it is "the high-order 16 bits" that we
2401 want, it is really the %high value. The complete value is
2402 calculated with a `addiu' of a LO16 relocation, just as with a
2403 HI16/LO16 pair. */
2404 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
2407 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2409 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value, 0, NULL,
2410 R_MIPS_GOT16);
2411 if (entry)
2412 return entry->gotidx;
2413 else
2414 return MINUS_ONE;
2417 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
2418 in the GOT. */
2420 static bfd_vma
2421 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
2422 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
2424 asection *sgot;
2425 bfd_vma gp;
2426 struct mips_got_info *g;
2428 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
2429 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
2430 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
2432 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
2435 /* Create a local GOT entry for VALUE. Return the index of the entry,
2436 or -1 if it could not be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
2437 create a TLS entry instead. */
2439 static struct mips_got_entry *
2440 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd,
2441 struct mips_got_info *gg,
2442 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value,
2443 unsigned long r_symndx,
2444 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2445 int r_type)
2447 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2448 struct mips_got_info *g;
2450 entry.abfd = NULL;
2451 entry.symndx = -1;
2452 entry.d.address = value;
2453 entry.tls_type = 0;
2455 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2456 if (g == NULL)
2458 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2459 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2462 /* We might have a symbol, H, if it has been forced local. Use the
2463 global entry then. It doesn't matter whether an entry is local
2464 or global for TLS, since the dynamic linker does not
2465 automatically relocate TLS GOT entries. */
2466 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->root.forced_local);
2467 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2469 struct mips_got_entry *p;
2471 entry.abfd = ibfd;
2472 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2474 entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
2475 entry.symndx = 0;
2476 entry.d.addend = 0;
2478 else if (h == NULL)
2480 entry.symndx = r_symndx;
2481 entry.d.addend = 0;
2483 else
2484 entry.d.h = h;
2486 p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
2487 htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
2489 BFD_ASSERT (p);
2490 return p;
2493 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2494 INSERT);
2495 if (*loc)
2496 return *loc;
2498 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2499 entry.tls_type = 0;
2501 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2503 if (! *loc)
2504 return NULL;
2506 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2508 if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
2510 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2511 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
2512 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2513 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2514 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2515 return NULL;
2518 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2519 (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2521 return *loc;
2524 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2525 appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space
2526 required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2527 known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During
2528 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the
2529 section symbols are added and the count is higher. */
2531 static bfd_boolean
2532 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2534 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2535 struct mips_got_info *g;
2536 bfd *dynobj;
2538 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2540 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2542 hsd.low = NULL;
2543 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2544 hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2545 /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2546 indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2547 primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2548 dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't
2549 referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2550 don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2551 too large offsets. */
2552 - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2553 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2554 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2555 elf_hash_table (info)),
2556 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2557 &hsd);
2559 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2560 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
2561 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2562 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2563 <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2565 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2566 table index in the GOT. */
2567 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2569 return TRUE;
2572 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2573 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2574 index. */
2576 static bfd_boolean
2577 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2579 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2581 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2582 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2584 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2585 at all. */
2586 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2587 return TRUE;
2589 /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2590 referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are
2591 referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2592 -1. */
2593 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2595 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2597 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2598 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2599 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2601 else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
2602 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2603 else
2605 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2607 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2608 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2611 return TRUE;
2614 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2615 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2616 posterity. */
2618 static bfd_boolean
2619 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2620 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2621 struct mips_got_info *g,
2622 unsigned char tls_flag)
2624 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2626 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2627 table. */
2628 if (h->dynindx == -1)
2630 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2632 case STV_INTERNAL:
2633 case STV_HIDDEN:
2634 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2635 break;
2637 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2638 return FALSE;
2641 entry.abfd = abfd;
2642 entry.symndx = -1;
2643 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2644 entry.tls_type = 0;
2646 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2647 INSERT);
2649 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2650 need to do it again. */
2651 if (*loc)
2653 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2654 return TRUE;
2657 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2659 if (! *loc)
2660 return FALSE;
2662 entry.gotidx = -1;
2663 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2665 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2667 if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2668 return TRUE;
2670 /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2671 there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the
2672 generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */
2673 if (tls_flag == 0)
2674 h->got.offset = 1;
2676 return TRUE;
2679 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2680 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
2682 static bfd_boolean
2683 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2684 struct mips_got_info *g,
2685 unsigned char tls_flag)
2687 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2689 entry.abfd = abfd;
2690 entry.symndx = symndx;
2691 entry.d.addend = addend;
2692 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2693 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2694 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2696 if (*loc)
2698 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
2700 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2701 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2703 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
2705 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2706 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2708 return TRUE;
2711 if (tls_flag != 0)
2713 entry.gotidx = -1;
2714 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2715 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
2716 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2717 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
2718 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2719 else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
2721 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
2722 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2725 else
2727 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2728 entry.tls_type = 0;
2731 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2733 if (! *loc)
2734 return FALSE;
2736 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2738 return TRUE;
2741 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
2743 static hashval_t
2744 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2746 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
2747 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
2749 return entry->bfd->id;
2752 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
2754 static int
2755 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2757 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
2758 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
2759 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
2760 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
2762 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
2765 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBDF. G must
2766 be the master GOT data. */
2768 static struct mips_got_info *
2769 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2771 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
2773 if (! g->bfd2got)
2774 return g;
2776 e.bfd = ibfd;
2777 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
2778 return p ? p->g : NULL;
2781 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
2782 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
2783 bfd requires. */
2785 static int
2786 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
2788 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2789 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2790 htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
2791 struct mips_got_info *g;
2792 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
2793 void **bfdgotp;
2795 /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd. Create one if
2796 none exists. */
2797 bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
2798 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
2799 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
2801 if (bfdgot != NULL)
2802 g = bfdgot->g;
2803 else
2805 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
2806 (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
2808 if (bfdgot == NULL)
2810 arg->obfd = 0;
2811 return 0;
2814 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
2816 bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
2817 bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
2818 bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
2819 if (g == NULL)
2821 arg->obfd = 0;
2822 return 0;
2825 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
2826 g->global_gotno = 0;
2827 g->local_gotno = 0;
2828 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
2829 g->tls_gotno = 0;
2830 g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
2831 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
2832 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
2833 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
2834 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
2836 arg->obfd = 0;
2837 return 0;
2840 g->bfd2got = NULL;
2841 g->next = NULL;
2844 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
2845 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
2846 if (*entryp != NULL)
2847 return 1;
2849 *entryp = entry;
2851 if (entry->tls_type)
2853 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
2854 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2855 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2856 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2858 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
2859 ++g->local_gotno;
2860 else
2861 ++g->global_gotno;
2863 return 1;
2866 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
2867 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
2868 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
2869 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
2870 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
2871 and then make make the new got current. */
2873 static int
2874 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
2876 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
2877 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
2878 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2879 unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
2880 unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
2881 unsigned int tcount = bfd2got->g->tls_gotno;
2882 unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
2883 bfd_boolean too_many_for_tls = FALSE;
2885 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
2886 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
2887 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
2888 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
2889 if (tcount > 0)
2891 unsigned int primary_total = lcount + tcount + arg->global_count;
2892 if (primary_total * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (bfd2got->bfd)
2893 >= MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (bfd2got->bfd))
2894 too_many_for_tls = TRUE;
2897 /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
2898 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
2899 if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt
2900 && ! too_many_for_tls)
2902 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
2903 arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
2905 /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
2906 the primary, merge them. The heuristics is conservative, but we
2907 don't have to squeeze it too hard. */
2908 else if (arg->primary && ! too_many_for_tls
2909 && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount + tcount) <= maxcnt)
2911 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
2912 int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
2913 int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
2914 int old_tcount = arg->primary->tls_gotno;
2916 bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
2918 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
2919 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
2920 arg);
2921 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
2922 return 0;
2924 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
2925 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
2926 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
2927 table anyway. */
2929 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
2930 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
2931 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->primary->tls_gotno);
2933 arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
2934 + arg->primary->global_gotno + arg->primary->tls_gotno;
2936 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
2937 else if (arg->current
2938 && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt)
2940 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
2941 int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
2942 int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
2943 int old_tcount = arg->current->tls_gotno;
2945 bfd2got->g = arg->current;
2947 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
2948 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
2949 arg);
2950 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
2951 return 0;
2953 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
2955 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
2956 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
2957 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->current->tls_gotno);
2959 arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
2960 + arg->current->global_gotno + arg->current->tls_gotno;
2962 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
2963 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
2964 overflows anyway. */
2965 else
2967 bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
2968 arg->current = bfd2got->g;
2970 arg->current_count = lcount + gcount + 2 * tcount;
2973 return 1;
2976 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. */
2978 static int
2979 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
2981 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2982 struct mips_got_info *g = p;
2984 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
2985 if (entry->tls_type == 0)
2986 return 1;
2988 if (entry->symndx == -1)
2990 /* There may be multiple mips_got_entry structs for a global variable
2991 if there is just one GOT. Just do this once. */
2992 if (g->next == NULL)
2994 if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
2995 return 1;
2996 entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
2999 else if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3001 /* Similarly, there may be multiple structs for the LDM entry. */
3002 if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
3004 entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
3005 return 1;
3009 /* Initialize the GOT offset. */
3010 entry->gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
3011 if (g->next == NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3012 entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = entry->gotidx;
3014 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3015 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
3016 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3017 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
3019 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3020 g->tls_ldm_offset = entry->gotidx;
3022 return 1;
3025 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
3026 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
3027 got) to the given VALUE.
3029 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
3030 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
3031 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
3032 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
3033 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
3034 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
3035 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
3036 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
3037 stub. */
3038 static int
3039 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
3041 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3042 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
3043 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
3044 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
3046 if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
3047 arg->needed_relocs +=
3048 mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
3049 entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3051 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
3052 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1
3053 && entry->d.h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
3055 if (g)
3057 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
3059 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
3060 if (arg->info->shared
3061 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
3062 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
3063 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
3064 ++arg->needed_relocs;
3066 else
3067 entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
3070 return 1;
3073 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
3074 as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */
3075 static int
3076 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3078 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3080 if (entry->abfd != NULL
3081 && entry->symndx == -1
3082 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
3083 entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
3085 return 1;
3088 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
3089 points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer
3090 to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may
3091 modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
3092 we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
3093 the traversal must be restarted. */
3094 static int
3095 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
3097 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3098 htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
3100 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3102 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
3104 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3105 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3106 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3108 if (entry->d.h == h)
3109 return 1;
3111 entry->d.h = h;
3113 /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
3114 it, and get the traversal restarted. */
3115 if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
3117 htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
3118 entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3119 if (! *entryp)
3120 *entryp = entry;
3121 /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
3122 moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
3123 process. */
3124 *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
3125 return 0;
3127 /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
3128 either too early or too late for that at this point. */
3131 return 1;
3134 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
3135 locations. */
3136 static void
3137 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3139 htab_t got_entries;
3143 got_entries = g->got_entries;
3145 htab_traverse (got_entries,
3146 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
3147 &got_entries);
3149 while (got_entries == NULL);
3152 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
3153 the primary GOT. */
3154 static bfd_vma
3155 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3157 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3158 return 0;
3160 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3161 if (! g)
3162 return 0;
3164 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
3166 g = g->next;
3168 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
3169 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3172 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
3173 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
3175 static bfd_boolean
3176 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3177 struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
3178 bfd_size_type pages)
3180 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
3181 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
3182 struct mips_got_info *gg;
3183 unsigned int assign;
3185 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
3186 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
3187 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3188 return FALSE;
3190 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
3191 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
3192 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
3194 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
3195 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
3196 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3197 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3198 return FALSE;
3200 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
3201 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
3202 /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate. We could
3203 compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
3204 uses, but it's probably not worth it. */
3205 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (abfd)
3206 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
3207 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO - pages);
3208 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
3209 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
3210 information. */
3211 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
3213 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
3214 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
3215 to be the primary GOT. */
3216 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3217 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3218 return FALSE;
3220 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
3221 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
3223 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
3224 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3225 if (g->next == NULL)
3226 return FALSE;
3228 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
3229 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
3230 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
3231 g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
3232 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
3233 g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3234 g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3235 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3236 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
3237 NULL);
3238 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
3239 return FALSE;
3240 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
3242 else
3243 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
3244 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
3246 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
3247 gg = g;
3248 g = g->next;
3250 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
3251 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
3252 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
3253 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
3254 list. */
3256 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
3257 void **bfdgotp;
3259 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3260 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3262 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3263 return FALSE;
3265 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
3266 bfdgot->g = g;
3267 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
3269 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
3270 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3273 /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
3274 in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
3275 arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
3276 referenced.
3278 GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
3279 the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
3280 symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
3281 the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
3282 helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
3283 follows IRIX's practice.
3285 The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
3286 global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
3287 an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
3288 the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
3289 preserved. */
3290 if (1)
3292 gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
3293 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
3294 set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
3296 else
3298 /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
3299 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
3300 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
3301 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
3302 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
3303 their entries can be omitted. */
3304 gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
3305 set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
3308 /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
3309 depends on the setting of VALUE). */
3310 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
3311 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3312 &set_got_offset_arg);
3313 set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
3314 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3315 &set_got_offset_arg);
3316 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
3317 return FALSE;
3319 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
3320 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
3321 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
3322 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
3323 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
3324 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
3325 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
3326 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
3327 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
3328 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
3329 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
3330 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
3331 points back to the master GOT. */
3332 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
3333 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
3334 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
3335 assign = 0;
3336 gg->next = gg;
3340 struct mips_got_info *gn;
3342 assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
3343 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
3344 g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
3345 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3347 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
3348 all non-TLS entries. */
3349 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
3350 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
3352 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
3353 list that gg points to. */
3354 gn = g->next;
3355 g->next = gg->next;
3356 gg->next = g;
3357 g = gn;
3359 /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
3360 stubs. */
3361 if (g)
3362 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
3364 while (g);
3366 got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
3367 + gg->next->global_gotno
3368 + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3370 return TRUE;
3374 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
3375 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
3377 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
3378 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
3379 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3380 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
3382 while (relocation < relend)
3384 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type)
3385 return relocation;
3387 ++relocation;
3390 /* We didn't find it. */
3391 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3392 return NULL;
3395 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */
3397 static bfd_boolean
3398 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
3399 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3400 asection **local_sections,
3401 bfd_boolean check_forced)
3403 unsigned long r_symndx;
3404 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3405 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3406 size_t extsymoff;
3408 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3409 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3410 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3412 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
3413 return TRUE;
3414 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
3415 return TRUE;
3417 if (check_forced)
3419 /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
3420 was forced local. */
3421 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3422 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
3423 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3424 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3425 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3426 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3427 if (h->root.forced_local)
3428 return TRUE;
3431 return FALSE;
3434 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
3436 bfd_vma
3437 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3439 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
3440 /* VALUE is negative. */
3441 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
3443 return value;
3446 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
3447 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
3448 BITS. */
3450 static bfd_boolean
3451 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3453 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
3455 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
3456 /* The value is too big. */
3457 return TRUE;
3458 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
3459 /* The value is too small. */
3460 return TRUE;
3462 /* All is well. */
3463 return FALSE;
3466 /* Calculate the %high function. */
3468 static bfd_vma
3469 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
3471 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
3474 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
3476 static bfd_vma
3477 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3479 #ifdef BFD64
3480 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
3481 #else
3482 abort ();
3483 return MINUS_ONE;
3484 #endif
3487 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
3489 static bfd_vma
3490 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3492 #ifdef BFD64
3493 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
3494 #else
3495 abort ();
3496 return MINUS_ONE;
3497 #endif
3500 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
3502 static bfd_boolean
3503 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
3504 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3506 flagword flags;
3507 register asection *s;
3509 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
3511 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3512 | SEC_READONLY);
3514 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
3515 if (s == NULL
3516 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
3517 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
3518 return FALSE;
3520 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
3523 return TRUE;
3526 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
3528 static bfd_boolean
3529 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3530 bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
3532 flagword flags;
3533 register asection *s;
3534 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3535 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
3536 struct mips_got_info *g;
3537 bfd_size_type amt;
3539 /* This function may be called more than once. */
3540 s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
3541 if (s)
3543 if (! maybe_exclude)
3544 s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
3545 return TRUE;
3548 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3549 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3551 if (maybe_exclude)
3552 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3554 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
3555 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
3556 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3557 if (s == NULL
3558 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3559 return FALSE;
3561 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
3562 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
3563 are not creating a global offset table. */
3564 bh = NULL;
3565 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
3566 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
3567 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
3568 return FALSE;
3570 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
3571 h->non_elf = 0;
3572 h->def_regular = 1;
3573 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
3575 if (info->shared
3576 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3577 return FALSE;
3579 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
3580 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
3581 if (g == NULL)
3582 return FALSE;
3583 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3584 g->global_gotno = 0;
3585 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3586 g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
3587 g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
3588 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3589 g->next = NULL;
3590 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3591 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3592 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3593 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3594 return FALSE;
3595 mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
3596 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
3597 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
3599 return TRUE;
3602 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
3603 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
3604 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
3606 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
3607 REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
3608 relocation must be JALX.
3610 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
3611 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
3612 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
3613 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
3615 static bfd_reloc_status_type
3616 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
3617 asection *input_section,
3618 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3619 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3620 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
3621 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
3622 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
3623 const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
3624 bfd_boolean save_addend)
3626 /* The eventual value we will return. */
3627 bfd_vma value;
3628 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
3629 occurring. */
3630 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
3631 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
3632 shared object file being produced. */
3633 bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
3634 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
3635 relocated. */
3636 bfd_vma p;
3637 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
3638 bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
3639 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
3640 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
3641 during execution. */
3642 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
3643 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
3644 located. */
3645 asection *sec = NULL;
3646 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
3647 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
3648 symbol. */
3649 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
3650 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
3651 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
3652 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
3653 "__gnu_local_gp". */
3654 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
3655 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3656 size_t extsymoff;
3657 unsigned long r_symndx;
3658 int r_type;
3659 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
3660 relocation value. */
3661 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
3662 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
3663 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
3665 /* Parse the relocation. */
3666 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3667 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3668 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
3669 + input_section->output_offset
3670 + relocation->r_offset);
3672 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
3673 overflowed_p = FALSE;
3675 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
3676 used in the array of hash table entries. */
3677 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3678 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3679 local_sections, FALSE);
3680 was_local_p = local_p;
3681 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
3682 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3683 else
3685 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
3686 must come before globals. */
3687 extsymoff = 0;
3690 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
3691 if (local_p)
3693 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
3695 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
3696 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
3698 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3699 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
3700 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
3701 symbol += sym->st_value;
3702 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
3703 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
3705 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
3706 addend -= symbol;
3707 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3710 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
3711 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
3712 ++symbol;
3714 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3715 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
3716 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
3717 sym->st_name);
3718 if (*namep == '\0')
3719 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
3721 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
3723 else
3725 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
3727 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
3728 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3729 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
3730 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3731 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3732 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3733 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3735 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3736 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
3738 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
3739 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
3740 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
3741 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
3743 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
3744 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
3745 if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16
3746 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
3747 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3749 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
3751 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
3752 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
3753 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
3754 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
3757 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
3758 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
3759 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
3760 its defined. */
3761 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3762 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3763 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
3765 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
3766 if (sec->output_section)
3767 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
3768 + sec->output_section->vma
3769 + sec->output_offset);
3770 else
3771 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
3773 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
3774 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
3775 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
3776 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
3777 addresses. */
3778 symbol = 0;
3779 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
3780 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
3781 symbol = 0;
3782 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
3783 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
3785 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
3786 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
3787 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
3788 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
3789 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
3790 somehow as well. */
3791 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
3792 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
3793 symbol = 0;
3795 else
3797 if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
3798 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
3799 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
3800 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
3801 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
3802 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
3803 symbol = 0;
3806 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
3809 /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
3810 need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
3811 a stub. */
3812 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
3813 && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
3814 || (local_p && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
3815 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
3816 && !mips_elf_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
3818 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
3819 have already noticed that we were going to need the
3820 stub. */
3821 if (local_p)
3822 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
3823 else
3825 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
3826 sec = h->fn_stub;
3829 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3831 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
3832 need to redirect the call to the stub. */
3833 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
3834 && h != NULL
3835 && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
3836 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
3838 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
3839 out which one to use by seeing which one appears in the input
3840 file. */
3841 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
3843 asection *o;
3845 sec = NULL;
3846 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
3848 if (strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o),
3849 CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
3851 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
3852 break;
3855 if (sec == NULL)
3856 sec = h->call_stub;
3858 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
3859 sec = h->call_stub;
3860 else
3861 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
3863 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
3864 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3867 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
3868 special jalx instruction. */
3869 *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
3870 && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
3871 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
3873 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3874 local_sections, TRUE);
3876 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
3877 and we're going to need it, get it now. */
3878 switch (r_type)
3880 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
3881 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
3882 /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
3883 bind locally. */
3884 local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
3885 if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
3886 break;
3887 /* Fall through. */
3889 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
3890 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
3891 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
3892 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
3893 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
3894 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
3895 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
3896 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
3897 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
3898 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
3899 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
3900 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
3902 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info, 0, 0, NULL,
3903 r_type);
3904 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
3905 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3907 else if (!local_p)
3909 /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
3910 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
3911 symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added
3912 as GOT_OFST. */
3913 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
3914 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3915 input_bfd,
3916 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h,
3917 r_type, info);
3918 if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
3919 && (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
3920 || (info->shared
3921 && (info->symbolic || h->root.dynindx == -1)
3922 && h->root.def_regular)))
3924 /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The
3925 symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
3926 We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */
3927 bfd *tmpbfd = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3928 asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (tmpbfd, FALSE);
3929 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (tmpbfd, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
3932 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16)
3933 /* There's no need to create a local GOT entry here; the
3934 calculation for a local GOT16 entry does not involve G. */
3935 break;
3936 else
3938 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd,
3939 info, symbol + addend, r_symndx, h,
3940 r_type);
3941 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
3942 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3945 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
3946 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3947 abfd, input_bfd, g);
3948 break;
3950 case R_MIPS_HI16:
3951 case R_MIPS_LO16:
3952 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
3953 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
3954 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
3955 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
3956 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
3957 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
3958 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
3959 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
3960 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj)
3961 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd,
3962 mips_elf_got_info
3963 (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, NULL),
3964 input_bfd);
3965 break;
3967 default:
3968 break;
3971 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
3972 symbol = gp;
3974 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
3975 switch (r_type)
3977 case R_MIPS_NONE:
3978 return bfd_reloc_continue;
3980 case R_MIPS_16:
3981 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
3982 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3983 break;
3985 case R_MIPS_32:
3986 case R_MIPS_REL32:
3987 case R_MIPS_64:
3988 if ((info->shared
3989 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
3990 && h != NULL
3991 && h->root.def_dynamic
3992 && !h->root.def_regular))
3993 && r_symndx != 0
3994 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3996 /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
3997 against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
3998 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
3999 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
4000 linker. */
4001 value = addend;
4002 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
4003 info,
4004 relocation,
4006 sec,
4007 symbol,
4008 &value,
4009 input_section))
4010 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4012 else
4014 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4015 value = symbol + addend;
4016 else
4017 value = addend;
4019 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4020 break;
4022 case R_MIPS_PC32:
4023 value = symbol + addend - p;
4024 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4025 break;
4027 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
4028 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
4029 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
4030 value = (value >> 2) & howto->dst_mask;
4031 break;
4033 case R_MIPS16_26:
4034 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
4035 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
4036 the output file that's different. That's handled in
4037 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
4038 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
4039 case R_MIPS_26:
4040 if (local_p)
4041 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
4042 else
4044 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
4045 if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4046 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
4048 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4049 break;
4051 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
4052 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
4053 & howto->dst_mask);
4054 break;
4056 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
4057 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4058 break;
4060 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
4061 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
4062 & howto->dst_mask);
4063 break;
4065 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
4066 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4067 break;
4069 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4070 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4071 if (!gp_disp_p)
4073 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
4074 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4076 else
4078 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4079 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4080 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4081 8: sll $v0,16
4082 12: addu $v0,$v1
4083 14: move $gp,$v0
4084 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4085 $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
4086 both reloc addends by 4. */
4087 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
4088 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
4089 else
4090 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
4091 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4093 break;
4095 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4096 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4097 if (!gp_disp_p)
4098 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
4099 else
4101 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4102 for this conditional. */
4103 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
4104 value = addend + gp - p;
4105 else
4106 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
4107 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4108 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
4109 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
4110 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
4111 this:
4113 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4114 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4115 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
4117 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4118 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
4119 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4120 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4121 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4122 not check for overflow here. */
4124 break;
4126 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4127 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
4128 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
4129 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
4130 here. */
4132 /* Fall through. */
4134 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4135 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
4136 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
4137 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
4138 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
4139 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4140 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
4141 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
4142 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
4143 if (howto->partial_inplace)
4144 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4145 value = symbol + addend - gp;
4146 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
4147 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
4148 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
4149 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
4150 to them before. */
4151 if (was_local_p)
4152 value += gp0;
4153 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4154 break;
4156 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4157 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4158 if (local_p)
4160 bfd_boolean forced;
4162 /* The special case is when the symbol is forced to be local. We
4163 need the full address in the GOT since no R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4164 follows. */
4165 forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4166 local_sections, FALSE);
4167 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4168 symbol + addend, forced);
4169 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4170 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4171 value
4172 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
4173 abfd, input_bfd, value);
4174 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4175 break;
4178 /* Fall through. */
4180 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4181 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4182 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4183 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4184 got_disp:
4185 value = g;
4186 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4187 break;
4189 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4190 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
4191 if (!save_addend)
4192 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4193 break;
4195 case R_MIPS_PC16:
4196 value = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16) + symbol - p;
4197 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4198 break;
4200 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4201 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4202 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
4203 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
4204 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
4205 value = g;
4206 value = mips_elf_high (value);
4207 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4208 break;
4210 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4211 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4212 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
4213 break;
4215 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4216 /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
4217 to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
4218 0. */
4219 if (! local_p)
4220 goto got_disp;
4221 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
4222 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4223 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4224 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
4225 abfd, input_bfd, value);
4226 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4227 break;
4229 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4230 if (local_p)
4231 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
4232 else
4233 value = addend;
4234 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4235 break;
4237 case R_MIPS_SUB:
4238 value = symbol - addend;
4239 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4240 break;
4242 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
4243 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
4244 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4245 break;
4247 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
4248 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
4249 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4250 break;
4252 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
4253 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
4254 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4255 break;
4257 case R_MIPS_JALR:
4258 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
4259 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
4260 branches to the PLT; that will wind up wasting time. */
4261 if (h != NULL && h->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4262 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4263 value = symbol + addend;
4264 break;
4266 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
4267 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4268 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
4269 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
4270 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4272 default:
4273 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
4274 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4277 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
4278 *valuep = value;
4279 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
4282 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
4284 static bfd_vma
4285 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
4286 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4287 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
4289 bfd_vma x;
4290 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4292 /* Obtain the bytes. */
4293 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
4295 return x;
4298 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
4299 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
4300 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
4301 relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
4302 for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
4303 unconditionally converted to JALX.
4305 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
4307 static bfd_boolean
4308 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4309 reloc_howto_type *howto,
4310 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4311 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
4312 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
4313 bfd_boolean require_jalx)
4315 bfd_vma x;
4316 bfd_byte *location;
4317 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4319 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
4320 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4322 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
4324 /* Obtain the current value. */
4325 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
4327 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
4328 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
4330 /* Set the field. */
4331 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
4333 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
4334 if (require_jalx)
4336 bfd_boolean ok;
4337 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
4338 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
4340 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
4341 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
4343 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
4344 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4346 else
4348 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
4349 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4352 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
4353 if (!ok)
4355 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4356 (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
4357 input_bfd,
4358 input_section,
4359 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
4360 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4361 return FALSE;
4364 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
4365 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4368 /* On the RM9000, bal is faster than jal, because bal uses branch
4369 prediction hardware. If we are linking for the RM9000, and we
4370 see jal, and bal fits, use it instead. Note that this
4371 transformation should be safe for all architectures. */
4372 if (bfd_get_mach (input_bfd) == bfd_mach_mips9000
4373 && !info->relocatable
4374 && !require_jalx
4375 && ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
4376 || (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR && x == 0x0320f809))) /* jalr t9 */
4378 bfd_vma addr;
4379 bfd_vma dest;
4380 bfd_signed_vma off;
4382 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
4383 + input_section->output_offset
4384 + relocation->r_offset
4385 + 4);
4386 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
4387 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
4388 else
4389 dest = value;
4390 off = dest - addr;
4391 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
4392 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
4395 /* Put the value into the output. */
4396 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
4398 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
4399 location);
4401 return TRUE;
4404 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */
4406 static bfd_boolean
4407 mips_elf_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
4409 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
4411 return (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
4412 || strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
4413 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0);
4416 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel.dyn section in ABFD. */
4418 static void
4419 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, unsigned int n)
4421 asection *s;
4423 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (abfd, FALSE);
4424 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4426 if (s->size == 0)
4428 /* Make room for a null element. */
4429 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4430 ++s->reloc_count;
4432 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4435 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
4436 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
4437 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
4438 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
4440 static bfd_boolean
4441 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
4442 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4443 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4444 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4445 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
4446 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
4448 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
4449 asection *sreloc;
4450 bfd *dynobj;
4451 int r_type;
4452 long indx;
4453 bfd_boolean defined_p;
4455 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
4456 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4457 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
4458 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
4459 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
4460 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
4461 < sreloc->size);
4463 outrel[0].r_offset =
4464 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
4465 outrel[1].r_offset =
4466 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
4467 outrel[2].r_offset =
4468 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
4470 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
4471 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
4472 return TRUE;
4474 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
4476 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
4477 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
4478 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
4479 *addendp += symbol;
4480 return TRUE;
4483 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
4484 in the relocation. */
4485 if (h != NULL
4486 && (! info->symbolic || !h->root.def_regular)
4487 /* h->root.dynindx may be -1 if this symbol was marked to
4488 become local. */
4489 && h->root.dynindx != -1)
4491 indx = h->root.dynindx;
4492 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4493 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
4494 else
4495 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
4496 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
4497 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
4498 undefined symbols. */
4499 defined_p = FALSE;
4501 else
4503 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
4504 indx = 0;
4505 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
4507 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4508 return FALSE;
4510 else
4512 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
4513 if (indx == 0)
4514 abort ();
4517 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
4518 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
4519 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
4520 local symbols because we used to generate them
4521 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
4522 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
4523 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
4524 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
4525 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
4526 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
4527 as well. */
4528 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
4529 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
4530 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
4531 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
4532 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4533 indx = 0;
4534 defined_p = TRUE;
4537 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
4538 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
4539 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
4540 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
4541 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4542 *addendp += symbol;
4544 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
4545 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
4546 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
4547 R_MIPS_REL32);
4548 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
4549 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
4550 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
4551 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
4552 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
4553 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
4554 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
4555 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
4556 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
4557 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
4558 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
4559 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
4560 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
4561 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
4562 ? R_MIPS_64
4563 : R_MIPS_NONE);
4564 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
4566 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
4567 correct location in the output file. */
4568 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4569 + input_section->output_offset);
4570 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4571 + input_section->output_offset);
4572 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4573 + input_section->output_offset);
4575 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
4576 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
4577 relocation format is non-standard. */
4578 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4580 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
4581 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4582 (sreloc->contents
4583 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
4585 else
4586 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
4587 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4588 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
4590 /* We've now added another relocation. */
4591 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
4593 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
4594 will be writing to it. */
4595 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
4596 |= SHF_WRITE;
4598 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
4599 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
4601 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
4602 bfd_byte *cr;
4604 if (scpt)
4606 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
4608 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
4609 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
4610 + input_section->output_section->vma
4611 + input_section->output_offset);
4612 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
4613 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
4614 else
4615 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
4616 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
4617 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
4619 cr = (scpt->contents
4620 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
4621 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
4622 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
4623 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
4624 + scpt->reloc_count));
4625 ++scpt->reloc_count;
4629 return TRUE;
4632 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
4634 unsigned long
4635 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
4637 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
4639 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
4640 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
4642 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
4643 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
4645 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
4646 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
4648 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
4649 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
4651 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
4652 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
4654 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
4655 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
4657 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
4658 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
4660 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
4661 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
4663 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
4664 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
4666 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
4667 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
4669 default:
4670 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
4672 default:
4673 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
4674 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
4675 break;
4677 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
4678 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
4679 break;
4681 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
4682 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
4683 break;
4685 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
4686 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
4687 break;
4689 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
4690 return bfd_mach_mips5;
4691 break;
4693 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
4694 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
4695 break;
4697 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
4698 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
4699 break;
4701 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
4702 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
4703 break;
4705 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
4706 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
4707 break;
4711 return 0;
4714 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
4716 static INLINE char *
4717 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
4719 flagword flags;
4721 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
4722 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
4724 case 0:
4725 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
4726 return "N32";
4727 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
4728 return "64";
4729 else
4730 return "none";
4731 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
4732 return "O32";
4733 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
4734 return "O64";
4735 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
4736 return "EABI32";
4737 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
4738 return "EABI64";
4739 default:
4740 return "unknown abi";
4744 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
4745 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
4746 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
4747 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
4748 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
4749 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
4750 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4751 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
4753 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
4754 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
4755 definition in a shared library. */
4756 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
4757 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4758 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
4760 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
4761 This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
4763 void
4764 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
4766 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
4768 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
4769 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
4771 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
4772 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
4773 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
4774 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
4775 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
4776 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
4777 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
4779 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
4780 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
4781 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
4782 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4783 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4784 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
4785 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
4786 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
4787 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4788 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4790 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4791 break;
4793 case SHN_COMMON:
4794 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
4795 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
4796 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
4797 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
4798 break;
4799 /* Fall through. */
4800 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
4801 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
4803 /* Initialize the small common section. */
4804 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
4805 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
4806 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4807 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4808 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
4809 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
4810 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
4811 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4812 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4814 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4815 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
4816 break;
4818 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
4819 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4820 break;
4822 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
4824 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
4826 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
4827 if (section != NULL)
4829 asym->section = section;
4830 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
4831 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
4832 base address to make it an offset. */
4833 asym->value -= section->vma;
4836 break;
4838 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
4840 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
4842 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
4843 if (section != NULL)
4845 asym->section = section;
4846 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
4847 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
4848 base address to make it an offset. */
4849 asym->value -= section->vma;
4852 break;
4856 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
4857 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
4859 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
4860 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
4861 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
4862 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
4863 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
4865 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
4866 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
4867 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
4868 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
4870 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
4871 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
4872 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
4873 We therefore take the following approach:
4875 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
4876 determine the pointer size.
4878 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
4879 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
4881 - Otherwise punt.
4883 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
4884 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
4885 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
4886 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
4887 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
4889 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
4890 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
4891 did so. */
4893 unsigned int
4894 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
4896 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
4897 return 8;
4898 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
4900 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
4902 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
4903 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
4904 if (long32_p && long64_p)
4905 return 0;
4906 if (long32_p)
4907 return 4;
4908 if (long64_p)
4909 return 8;
4911 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
4912 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
4913 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
4914 == R_MIPS_64))
4915 return 8;
4917 return 0;
4919 return 4;
4922 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
4923 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
4924 same address. For example, if we have code like:
4926 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
4927 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
4928 jalr $25
4930 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
4931 will jump there rather than to .text.
4933 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
4934 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
4936 bfd_boolean
4937 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
4939 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
4942 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
4943 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
4944 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
4945 a better way. */
4947 bfd_boolean
4948 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
4950 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
4951 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
4953 bfd_byte buf[4];
4955 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
4956 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
4958 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
4959 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
4960 SEEK_SET) != 0)
4961 return FALSE;
4962 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
4963 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
4964 return FALSE;
4967 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
4968 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
4969 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
4970 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
4972 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
4974 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
4975 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
4976 so that we don't have to read them again.
4977 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
4978 through the section contents to see if there is an
4979 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
4981 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
4982 l = contents;
4983 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
4984 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
4986 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
4988 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
4989 &intopt);
4990 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
4992 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4993 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
4994 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
4995 break;
4997 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
4999 bfd_byte buf[8];
5001 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5002 (hdr->sh_offset
5003 + (l - contents)
5004 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5005 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
5006 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5007 return FALSE;
5008 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5009 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
5010 return FALSE;
5012 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5014 bfd_byte buf[4];
5016 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5017 (hdr->sh_offset
5018 + (l - contents)
5019 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5020 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
5021 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5022 return FALSE;
5023 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5024 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5025 return FALSE;
5027 l += intopt.size;
5031 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
5033 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
5035 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5036 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
5037 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
5039 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5040 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5042 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
5044 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5045 hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
5047 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
5049 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5050 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5052 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
5054 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
5055 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5057 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
5059 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
5061 unsigned int adjust;
5063 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
5064 if (adjust != 0)
5065 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
5070 return TRUE;
5073 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
5074 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
5075 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
5077 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
5078 how to. */
5080 bfd_boolean
5081 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
5082 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
5083 const char *name,
5084 int shindex)
5086 flagword flags = 0;
5088 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
5089 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
5090 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
5091 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
5092 probably get away with this. */
5093 switch (hdr->sh_type)
5095 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
5096 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
5097 return FALSE;
5098 break;
5099 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
5100 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
5101 return FALSE;
5102 break;
5103 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
5104 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
5105 return FALSE;
5106 break;
5107 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
5108 if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) != 0)
5109 return FALSE;
5110 break;
5111 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
5112 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
5113 return FALSE;
5114 break;
5115 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
5116 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
5117 return FALSE;
5118 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
5119 break;
5120 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
5121 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
5122 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
5123 return FALSE;
5124 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
5125 break;
5126 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
5127 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
5128 return FALSE;
5129 break;
5130 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
5131 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) != 0)
5132 return FALSE;
5133 break;
5134 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
5135 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5136 return FALSE;
5137 break;
5138 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
5139 if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) != 0)
5140 return FALSE;
5141 break;
5142 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
5143 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
5144 return FALSE;
5145 break;
5146 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
5147 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) != 0
5148 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
5149 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) != 0)
5150 return FALSE;
5151 break;
5152 default:
5153 break;
5156 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
5157 return FALSE;
5159 if (flags)
5161 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5162 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
5163 hdr->bfd_section)
5164 | flags)))
5165 return FALSE;
5168 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
5170 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
5171 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
5172 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
5173 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
5174 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
5176 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
5177 Elf32_RegInfo s;
5179 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5180 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
5181 return FALSE;
5182 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
5183 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
5186 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
5187 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
5188 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
5189 they should agree. */
5190 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
5192 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5194 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
5195 if (contents == NULL)
5196 return FALSE;
5197 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
5198 0, hdr->sh_size))
5200 free (contents);
5201 return FALSE;
5203 l = contents;
5204 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5205 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5207 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5209 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5210 &intopt);
5211 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5213 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5214 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5215 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5216 break;
5218 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5220 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
5222 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
5223 (abfd,
5224 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
5225 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5226 &intreg);
5227 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5229 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5231 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
5233 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
5234 (abfd,
5235 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
5236 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5237 &intreg);
5238 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5240 l += intopt.size;
5242 free (contents);
5245 return TRUE;
5248 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
5249 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
5250 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5252 bfd_boolean
5253 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
5255 register const char *name;
5256 unsigned int sh_type;
5258 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5259 sh_type = hdr->sh_type;
5261 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
5263 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
5264 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
5265 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5267 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
5268 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
5269 else if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
5271 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
5272 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
5273 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5275 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
5276 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
5277 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
5279 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
5280 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
5281 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5282 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5283 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5284 else
5285 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5287 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
5289 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
5290 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
5291 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5292 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5294 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5295 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5296 else
5297 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5299 else
5300 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5302 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5303 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
5304 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
5305 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
5307 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5308 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5309 #if 0
5310 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
5311 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
5312 #endif
5314 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
5315 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
5316 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5317 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
5318 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
5319 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
5320 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5321 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
5323 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
5324 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5326 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", strlen (".MIPS.content")) == 0)
5328 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
5329 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5330 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5332 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5334 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
5335 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5336 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5338 else if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) == 0)
5339 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
5340 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
5342 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
5343 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
5344 final_write_processing. */
5346 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0
5347 || strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
5348 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0)
5350 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
5351 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5352 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5354 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
5356 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
5357 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
5358 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
5361 /* In the unlikely event a special section is empty it has to lose its
5362 special meaning. This may happen e.g. when using `strip' with the
5363 "--only-keep-debug" option. */
5364 if (sec->size > 0 && !(sec->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5365 hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
5367 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
5368 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
5369 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
5370 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
5371 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
5373 return TRUE;
5376 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
5377 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
5378 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
5379 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
5380 the .scommon section. */
5382 bfd_boolean
5383 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5384 asection *sec, int *retval)
5386 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
5388 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5389 return TRUE;
5391 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
5393 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
5394 return TRUE;
5396 return FALSE;
5399 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
5400 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
5402 bfd_boolean
5403 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5404 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
5405 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5406 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
5408 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5409 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
5410 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
5412 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
5413 *namep = NULL;
5414 return TRUE;
5417 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
5418 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
5419 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
5420 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
5421 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
5422 is not done for them. */
5423 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
5424 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5425 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
5427 *namep = NULL;
5428 return TRUE;
5431 switch (sym->st_shndx)
5433 case SHN_COMMON:
5434 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5435 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
5436 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5437 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5438 break;
5439 /* Fall through. */
5440 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5441 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
5442 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
5443 *valp = sym->st_size;
5444 break;
5446 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5447 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5448 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
5450 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
5451 asection *elf_text_section;
5452 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5454 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5455 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
5456 return FALSE;
5458 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5459 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5460 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
5461 return FALSE;
5463 /* Initialize the section. */
5465 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
5466 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5468 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5469 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
5471 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
5472 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5473 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
5474 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
5475 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
5476 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5477 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
5479 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5480 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5481 so I took it out. */
5482 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
5483 break;
5485 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5486 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
5487 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5488 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5489 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
5491 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
5492 asection *elf_data_section;
5493 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5495 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5496 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
5497 return FALSE;
5499 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5500 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5501 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
5502 return FALSE;
5504 /* Initialize the section. */
5506 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
5507 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5509 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5510 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
5512 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
5513 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5514 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
5515 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
5516 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
5517 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5518 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
5520 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5521 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5522 so I took it out. */
5523 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
5524 break;
5526 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5527 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5528 break;
5531 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5532 && ! info->shared
5533 && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
5534 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
5536 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5537 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5539 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
5540 bh = NULL;
5541 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5542 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
5543 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5544 return FALSE;
5546 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5547 h->non_elf = 0;
5548 h->def_regular = 1;
5549 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5551 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5552 return FALSE;
5554 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
5557 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
5558 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
5559 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
5560 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5561 ++*valp;
5563 return TRUE;
5566 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
5567 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
5568 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
5570 bfd_boolean
5571 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
5572 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5573 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
5574 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5576 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
5577 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
5578 common in the output file. */
5579 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
5580 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
5581 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5583 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5584 sym->st_value &= ~1;
5586 return TRUE;
5589 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
5591 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
5593 bfd_boolean
5594 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5596 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5597 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5598 flagword flags;
5599 register asection *s;
5600 const char * const *namep;
5602 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5603 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
5605 /* Mips ABI requests the .dynamic section to be read only. */
5606 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5607 if (s != NULL)
5609 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
5610 return FALSE;
5613 /* We need to create .got section. */
5614 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
5615 return FALSE;
5617 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, TRUE))
5618 return FALSE;
5620 /* Create .stub section. */
5621 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5622 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
5624 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
5625 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
5626 flags | SEC_CODE);
5627 if (s == NULL
5628 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5629 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5630 return FALSE;
5633 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
5634 && !info->shared
5635 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
5637 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
5638 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
5639 if (s == NULL
5640 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5641 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5642 return FALSE;
5645 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
5646 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
5647 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
5648 the linker takes such action. */
5649 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
5651 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
5653 bh = NULL;
5654 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5655 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
5656 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5657 return FALSE;
5659 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5660 h->non_elf = 0;
5661 h->def_regular = 1;
5662 h->type = STT_SECTION;
5664 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5665 return FALSE;
5668 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
5669 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5671 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
5672 return FALSE;
5675 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
5676 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
5677 if (s != NULL)
5678 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5679 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
5680 if (s != NULL)
5681 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5682 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
5683 if (s != NULL)
5684 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5685 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
5686 if (s != NULL)
5687 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5688 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5689 if (s != NULL)
5690 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5693 if (!info->shared)
5695 const char *name;
5697 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
5698 bh = NULL;
5699 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5700 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
5701 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5702 return FALSE;
5704 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5705 h->non_elf = 0;
5706 h->def_regular = 1;
5707 h->type = STT_SECTION;
5709 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5710 return FALSE;
5712 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
5714 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
5715 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
5716 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
5717 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
5718 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
5719 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5721 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
5722 bh = NULL;
5723 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5724 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
5725 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5726 return FALSE;
5728 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5729 h->non_elf = 0;
5730 h->def_regular = 1;
5731 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5733 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5734 return FALSE;
5738 return TRUE;
5741 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
5742 allocate space in the global offset table. */
5744 bfd_boolean
5745 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5746 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
5748 const char *name;
5749 bfd *dynobj;
5750 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5751 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5752 struct mips_got_info *g;
5753 size_t extsymoff;
5754 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
5755 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
5756 asection *sgot;
5757 asection *sreloc;
5758 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5760 if (info->relocatable)
5761 return TRUE;
5763 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5764 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
5765 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
5766 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5768 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
5770 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5771 if (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0)
5773 unsigned long r_symndx;
5775 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
5776 this is for. */
5778 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
5780 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
5781 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
5783 asection *o;
5785 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
5786 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
5787 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
5788 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
5790 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
5791 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
5793 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
5794 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
5795 || o->reloc_count == 0
5796 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), FN_STUB,
5797 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
5798 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_STUB,
5799 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
5800 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_FP_STUB,
5801 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5802 continue;
5804 sec_relocs
5805 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
5806 info->keep_memory);
5807 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
5808 return FALSE;
5810 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
5811 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
5812 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
5813 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
5814 break;
5816 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
5817 free (sec_relocs);
5819 if (r < rend)
5820 break;
5823 if (o == NULL)
5825 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
5826 not need it. Since this function is called before
5827 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
5828 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
5829 flag. */
5830 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5831 return TRUE;
5834 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
5835 this BFD. */
5836 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
5838 unsigned long symcount;
5839 asection **n;
5840 bfd_size_type amt;
5842 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
5843 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
5844 else
5845 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5846 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
5847 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5848 if (n == NULL)
5849 return FALSE;
5850 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
5853 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
5855 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
5856 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
5857 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
5858 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
5860 else
5862 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5864 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5865 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5867 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
5868 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
5869 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
5871 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
5873 h->fn_stub = sec;
5874 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
5877 else if (strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
5878 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5880 unsigned long r_symndx;
5881 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5882 asection **loc;
5884 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
5885 this is for. */
5887 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
5889 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
5890 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
5892 /* This stub was actually built for a static symbol defined
5893 in the same file. We assume that all static symbols in
5894 mips16 code are themselves mips16, so we can simply
5895 discard this stub. Since this function is called before
5896 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we can
5897 easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
5898 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5899 return TRUE;
5902 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5903 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5905 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
5907 if (strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5908 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
5909 else
5910 loc = &h->call_stub;
5912 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
5913 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
5914 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
5915 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
5916 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. We can also discard this section if we
5917 happen to already know that this is a mips16 function; it is
5918 not necessary to check this here, as it is checked later, but
5919 it is slightly faster to check now. */
5920 if (*loc != NULL || h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
5922 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5923 return TRUE;
5926 *loc = sec;
5927 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
5930 if (dynobj == NULL)
5932 sgot = NULL;
5933 g = NULL;
5935 else
5937 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
5938 if (sgot == NULL)
5939 g = NULL;
5940 else
5942 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
5943 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
5944 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
5948 sreloc = NULL;
5949 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5950 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
5951 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
5953 unsigned long r_symndx;
5954 unsigned int r_type;
5955 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5957 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
5958 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
5960 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
5961 h = NULL;
5962 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
5964 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5965 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
5966 abfd, name);
5967 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5968 return FALSE;
5970 else
5972 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
5974 /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */
5975 if (h != NULL)
5977 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5978 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
5982 /* Some relocs require a global offset table. */
5983 if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
5985 switch (r_type)
5987 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5988 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5989 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5990 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5991 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5992 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5993 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5994 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
5995 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5996 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
5997 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
5998 if (dynobj == NULL)
5999 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6000 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
6001 return FALSE;
6002 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6003 break;
6005 case R_MIPS_32:
6006 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6007 case R_MIPS_64:
6008 if (dynobj == NULL
6009 && (info->shared || h != NULL)
6010 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6011 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6012 break;
6014 default:
6015 break;
6019 if (!h && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
6020 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
6021 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP))
6023 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
6024 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
6025 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
6026 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
6027 R_MIPS_CALL16. We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
6028 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
6029 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
6030 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6031 rel->r_addend, g, 0))
6032 return FALSE;
6035 switch (r_type)
6037 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6038 if (h == NULL)
6040 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6041 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
6042 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6043 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6044 return FALSE;
6046 /* Fall through. */
6048 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6049 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6050 if (h != NULL)
6052 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
6053 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6054 return FALSE;
6056 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
6057 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
6058 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
6059 h->needs_plt = 1;
6060 h->type = STT_FUNC;
6062 break;
6064 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6065 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
6066 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
6067 if (h == NULL)
6068 break;
6069 else
6071 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6072 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6074 while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6075 || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6076 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6077 hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
6079 if (hmips->root.def_regular
6080 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
6081 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
6082 break;
6084 /* Fall through. */
6086 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6087 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6088 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6089 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6090 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6091 return FALSE;
6092 break;
6094 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6095 if (info->shared)
6096 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
6097 /* Fall through */
6099 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6100 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
6102 r_symndx = 0;
6103 h = NULL;
6105 /* Fall through */
6107 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6108 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
6109 for TLS GD relocations. */
6111 unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
6112 ? GOT_TLS_GD
6113 : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
6114 ? GOT_TLS_LDM
6115 : GOT_TLS_IE);
6116 if (h != NULL)
6118 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6119 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6120 hmips->tls_type |= flag;
6122 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, flag))
6123 return FALSE;
6125 else
6127 BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != 0);
6129 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6130 rel->r_addend, g, flag))
6131 return FALSE;
6134 break;
6136 case R_MIPS_32:
6137 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6138 case R_MIPS_64:
6139 if ((info->shared || h != NULL)
6140 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6142 if (sreloc == NULL)
6144 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, TRUE);
6145 if (sreloc == NULL)
6146 return FALSE;
6148 #define MIPS_READONLY_SECTION (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)
6149 if (info->shared)
6151 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
6152 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
6153 relocs. We make room for this reloc in the
6154 .rel.dyn reloc section. */
6155 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, 1);
6156 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6157 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6158 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6159 relocations against the text segment. */
6160 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6162 else
6164 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6166 /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
6167 defined in a dynamic object. */
6168 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6169 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
6170 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6171 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6172 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
6173 are relocations against the text segment. */
6174 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
6177 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
6178 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
6179 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
6180 dynamic relocations against it. */
6181 if (h != NULL)
6183 if (dynobj == NULL)
6184 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6185 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
6186 return FALSE;
6187 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6188 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6189 return FALSE;
6193 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6194 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6195 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6196 break;
6198 case R_MIPS_26:
6199 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
6200 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
6201 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6202 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6203 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6204 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6205 break;
6207 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
6208 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
6209 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6210 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6211 return FALSE;
6212 break;
6214 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
6215 used. Record for later use during GC. */
6216 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6217 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6218 return FALSE;
6219 break;
6221 default:
6222 break;
6225 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
6226 related to taking the function's address. */
6227 switch (r_type)
6229 default:
6230 if (h != NULL)
6232 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6234 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6235 mh->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
6237 break;
6238 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6239 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6240 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6241 case R_MIPS_JALR:
6242 break;
6245 /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
6246 symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
6247 References from a stub section do not count. */
6248 if (h != NULL
6249 && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
6250 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), FN_STUB,
6251 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) != 0
6252 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_STUB,
6253 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) != 0
6254 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_FP_STUB,
6255 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) != 0)
6257 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6259 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6260 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
6264 return TRUE;
6267 bfd_boolean
6268 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
6269 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6270 bfd_boolean *again)
6272 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6273 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
6274 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6275 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6276 size_t extsymoff;
6277 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
6278 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
6279 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6281 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
6282 *again = FALSE;
6284 if (link_info->relocatable)
6285 return TRUE;
6287 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
6288 link_info->keep_memory);
6289 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6290 return TRUE;
6292 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
6293 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6294 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6295 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6297 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6299 bfd_vma symval;
6300 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
6301 unsigned int r_type;
6302 unsigned long r_symndx;
6303 asection *sym_sec;
6304 unsigned long instruction;
6306 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
6307 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
6308 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
6309 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
6310 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
6311 continue;
6313 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
6314 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
6315 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
6317 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
6318 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6319 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6321 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6322 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6323 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6325 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
6326 skip it. */
6327 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6328 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6329 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
6330 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
6331 && !h->root.forced_local))
6332 continue;
6334 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
6335 if (sym_sec->output_section)
6336 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
6337 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6338 + sym_sec->output_offset);
6339 else
6340 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
6342 else
6344 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6346 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
6347 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
6349 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6350 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6351 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
6352 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
6353 NULL, NULL, NULL);
6354 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6355 goto relax_return;
6358 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
6359 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
6360 continue;
6361 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6362 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6363 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
6364 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
6365 else
6366 sym_sec
6367 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
6368 symval = isym->st_value
6369 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6370 + sym_sec->output_offset;
6373 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
6374 branch target. */
6375 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
6376 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
6378 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
6379 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
6380 continue;
6382 sym_offset >>= 2;
6384 /* Check that it's in range. */
6385 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
6386 continue;
6388 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
6389 if (contents == NULL)
6391 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6392 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6393 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6394 else
6396 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6397 goto relax_return;
6401 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
6403 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
6404 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
6405 instruction = 0x04110000;
6406 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
6407 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
6408 instruction = 0x10000000;
6409 else
6410 continue;
6412 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
6413 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
6414 changed_contents = TRUE;
6417 if (contents != NULL
6418 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6420 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
6421 free (contents);
6422 else
6424 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6425 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6428 return TRUE;
6430 relax_return:
6431 if (contents != NULL
6432 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6433 free (contents);
6434 return FALSE;
6437 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6438 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6439 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6440 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6441 understand. */
6443 bfd_boolean
6444 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6445 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6447 bfd *dynobj;
6448 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6449 asection *s;
6451 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6453 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
6454 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
6455 && (h->needs_plt
6456 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
6457 || (h->def_dynamic
6458 && h->ref_regular
6459 && !h->def_regular)));
6461 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
6462 any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
6463 file. */
6464 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6465 if (! info->relocatable
6466 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
6467 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6468 || !h->def_regular))
6470 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj,
6471 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
6472 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
6473 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
6474 against the text segment. */
6475 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6478 /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */
6479 if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
6480 && h->needs_plt)
6482 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6483 return TRUE;
6485 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
6486 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
6487 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
6488 executable and the shared library. */
6489 if (!h->def_regular)
6491 /* We need .stub section. */
6492 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
6493 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
6494 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6496 h->root.u.def.section = s;
6497 h->root.u.def.value = s->size;
6499 /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */
6500 h->plt.offset = s->size;
6502 /* Make room for this stub code. */
6503 s->size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
6505 /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
6506 of this symbol in .dynsym section. */
6507 return TRUE;
6510 else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
6511 && !h->needs_plt)
6513 /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
6514 the dynamic linker will take care of this. */
6515 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
6516 return TRUE;
6519 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
6520 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
6521 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
6522 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
6524 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6525 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
6526 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
6527 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
6528 return TRUE;
6531 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
6532 is not a function. */
6534 return TRUE;
6537 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
6538 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
6539 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
6541 bfd_boolean
6542 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
6543 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6545 asection *ri;
6547 bfd *dynobj;
6548 asection *s;
6549 struct mips_got_info *g;
6550 int i;
6551 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
6552 bfd_size_type local_gotno;
6553 bfd *sub;
6554 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
6556 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
6557 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
6558 if (ri != NULL)
6559 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
6561 if (! (info->relocatable
6562 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
6563 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
6564 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
6566 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6567 if (dynobj == NULL)
6568 /* Relocatable links don't have it. */
6569 return TRUE;
6571 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
6572 if (s == NULL)
6573 return TRUE;
6575 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
6576 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
6577 required. */
6578 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
6580 asection *subsection;
6582 for (subsection = sub->sections;
6583 subsection;
6584 subsection = subsection->next)
6586 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
6587 continue;
6588 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
6589 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
6593 /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
6594 a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
6595 higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
6596 that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We
6597 do that here. */
6598 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
6599 return FALSE;
6601 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
6602 i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
6603 else
6604 /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
6605 relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */
6606 i = 0;
6608 /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
6609 one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
6610 rld. */
6611 loadable_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE * (i + 1);
6613 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of
6614 contiguous sections. Is 5 enough? */
6615 local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
6617 g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
6618 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6620 g->global_gotno = i;
6621 s->size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6623 /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
6624 instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
6625 entries for one global symbol from multiple input files. */
6626 count_tls_arg.info = info;
6627 count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
6628 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
6629 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
6630 &count_tls_arg);
6631 g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
6632 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6634 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
6636 if (s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (output_bfd))
6638 if (! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
6639 return FALSE;
6641 else
6643 /* Set up TLS entries for the first GOT. */
6644 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
6645 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
6648 return TRUE;
6651 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
6653 bfd_boolean
6654 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
6655 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6657 bfd *dynobj;
6658 asection *s;
6659 bfd_boolean reltext;
6661 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6662 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
6664 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6666 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
6667 if (info->executable)
6669 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
6670 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6671 s->size
6672 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
6673 s->contents
6674 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
6678 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
6679 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
6680 memory for them. */
6681 reltext = FALSE;
6682 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6684 const char *name;
6686 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
6687 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
6688 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
6690 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
6691 continue;
6693 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) == 0)
6695 if (s->size != 0)
6697 const char *outname;
6698 asection *target;
6700 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
6701 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
6702 If the relocation section is .rel.dyn, we always
6703 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
6704 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
6705 not. */
6706 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
6707 s->output_section);
6708 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
6709 if ((target != NULL
6710 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
6711 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6712 || strcmp (outname, ".rel.dyn") == 0)
6713 reltext = TRUE;
6715 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
6716 to copy relocs into the output file. */
6717 if (strcmp (name, ".rel.dyn") != 0)
6718 s->reloc_count = 0;
6720 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
6721 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
6722 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
6723 will move them around between input sections'
6724 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
6725 broken, so don't let it run. */
6726 info->combreloc = 0;
6729 else if (strncmp (name, ".got", 4) == 0)
6731 /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
6732 most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
6733 to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
6734 hash tables. */
6735 struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
6736 struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
6737 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
6738 unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
6740 if (gg->next)
6742 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6743 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
6745 /* NOTE 2005-02-03: How can this call, or the next, ever
6746 find any indirect entries to resolve? They were all
6747 resolved in mips_elf_multi_got. */
6748 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
6749 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
6751 unsigned int save_assign;
6753 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
6755 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
6756 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
6757 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
6758 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
6759 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
6760 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
6761 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
6762 &set_got_offset_arg);
6763 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
6764 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
6765 <= g->global_gotno);
6767 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
6768 if (info->shared)
6770 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
6771 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
6772 + g->next->global_gotno
6773 + g->next->tls_gotno
6774 + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO);
6778 else
6780 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
6781 arg.info = info;
6782 arg.needed = 0;
6784 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs,
6785 &arg);
6786 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
6787 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
6788 &arg);
6790 needed_relocs += arg.needed;
6793 if (needed_relocs)
6794 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, needed_relocs);
6796 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
6798 /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
6799 of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */
6800 s->size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
6802 else if (! info->shared
6803 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
6804 && strncmp (name, ".rld_map", 8) == 0)
6806 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
6807 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
6808 s->size += 4;
6810 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
6811 && strncmp (name, ".compact_rel", 12) == 0)
6812 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
6813 else if (strncmp (name, ".init", 5) != 0)
6815 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
6816 continue;
6819 if (s->size == 0)
6821 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6822 continue;
6825 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
6826 continue;
6828 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
6829 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
6830 if (s->contents == NULL)
6832 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
6833 return FALSE;
6837 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6839 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
6840 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
6841 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
6842 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
6843 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
6844 if (! info->shared)
6846 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
6847 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. */
6848 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
6849 return FALSE;
6850 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6852 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
6853 return FALSE;
6856 else
6858 /* Shared libraries on traditional mips have DT_DEBUG. */
6859 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6861 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
6862 return FALSE;
6866 if (reltext && SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6867 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6869 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
6871 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
6872 return FALSE;
6875 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
6876 return FALSE;
6878 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE))
6880 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
6881 return FALSE;
6883 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
6884 return FALSE;
6886 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
6887 return FALSE;
6890 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
6891 return FALSE;
6893 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
6894 return FALSE;
6896 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
6897 return FALSE;
6899 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
6900 return FALSE;
6902 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
6903 return FALSE;
6905 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
6906 return FALSE;
6908 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
6909 return FALSE;
6911 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
6912 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
6913 return FALSE;
6915 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
6916 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
6917 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
6918 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
6919 return FALSE;
6922 return TRUE;
6925 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
6927 bfd_boolean
6928 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6929 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
6930 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6931 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6932 asection **local_sections)
6934 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6935 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6936 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6937 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
6938 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6940 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
6941 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6942 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
6944 const char *name;
6945 bfd_vma value = 0;
6946 reloc_howto_type *howto;
6947 bfd_boolean require_jalx;
6948 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
6949 REL relocation. */
6950 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
6951 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
6952 const char *msg;
6954 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
6955 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
6957 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
6958 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
6959 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
6960 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
6961 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
6962 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
6963 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
6965 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
6966 of the reloc. */
6967 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
6968 rel->r_offset += 4;
6970 else
6971 /* NewABI defaults to RELA relocations. */
6972 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
6973 NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
6974 && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
6975 (input_bfd, input_section,
6976 rel - relocs)));
6978 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
6980 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6982 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
6983 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
6984 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
6985 RELA relocation. To determine which flavor or relocation
6986 this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
6987 REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */
6988 rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
6989 if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
6990 >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
6991 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
6992 if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
6994 bfd_byte *location = contents + rel->r_offset;
6996 /* Note that this is a REL relocation. */
6997 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
6999 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
7000 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7001 location);
7002 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
7003 contents);
7004 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7005 location);
7007 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7009 /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
7010 combination of the addend stored in two different
7011 relocations. */
7012 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
7013 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
7014 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
7015 local_sections, FALSE)))
7017 bfd_vma l;
7018 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7019 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7020 bfd_byte *lo16_location;
7021 int lo16_type;
7023 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
7024 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7025 else
7026 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7028 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
7029 left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
7030 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the code does
7031 a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
7032 the LO16 value.)
7034 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7036 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16
7037 relocation must be immediately following.
7038 However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next relocation
7039 may be a composed relocation consisting of
7040 several relocations for the same address. In
7041 that case, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation may occur
7042 as one of these. We permit a similar extension
7043 in general, as that is useful for GCC. */
7044 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd,
7045 lo16_type,
7046 rel, relend);
7047 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7048 return FALSE;
7050 lo16_location = contents + lo16_relocation->r_offset;
7052 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
7053 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd,
7054 lo16_type, FALSE);
7055 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type, FALSE,
7056 lo16_location);
7057 l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto, lo16_relocation,
7058 input_bfd, contents);
7059 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type, FALSE,
7060 lo16_location);
7061 l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
7062 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7063 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7065 addend <<= 16;
7067 /* Compute the combined addend. */
7068 addend += l;
7070 else
7071 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
7073 else
7074 addend = rel->r_addend;
7077 if (info->relocatable)
7079 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7080 unsigned long r_symndx;
7082 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
7083 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7084 rel->r_offset -= 4;
7086 /* Since we're just relocating, all we need to do is copy
7087 the relocations back out to the object file, unless
7088 they're against a section symbol, in which case we need
7089 to adjust by the section offset, or unless they're GP
7090 relative in which case we need to adjust by the amount
7091 that we're adjusting GP in this relocatable object. */
7093 if (! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections,
7094 FALSE))
7095 /* There's nothing to do for non-local relocations. */
7096 continue;
7098 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
7099 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
7100 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
7101 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
7102 addend -= (_bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
7103 - _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd));
7105 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7106 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7107 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
7108 /* Adjust the addend appropriately. */
7109 addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
7111 if (rela_relocation_p)
7112 /* If this is a RELA relocation, just update the addend. */
7113 rel->r_addend = addend;
7114 else
7116 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
7117 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
7118 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
7119 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
7120 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
7121 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
7122 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
7123 else
7124 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
7126 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
7127 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
7128 source of the addend in the final link. */
7129 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7131 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7132 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7133 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
7134 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
7135 but for endianness. */
7137 bfd_vma sign_bits;
7138 bfd_vma low_bits;
7139 bfd_vma high_bits;
7141 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7142 #ifdef BFD64
7143 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7144 #else
7145 sign_bits = -1;
7146 #endif
7147 else
7148 sign_bits = 0;
7150 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7151 do two separate stores. */
7152 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7154 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7155 first. */
7156 low_bits = sign_bits;
7157 high_bits = addend;
7159 else
7161 low_bits = addend;
7162 high_bits = sign_bits;
7164 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7165 contents + rel->r_offset);
7166 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7167 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7168 continue;
7171 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
7172 input_bfd, input_section,
7173 contents, FALSE))
7174 return FALSE;
7177 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
7178 continue;
7181 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
7182 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
7183 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
7184 for the next. */
7185 if (rel + 1 < relend
7186 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
7187 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
7188 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
7189 else
7190 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
7192 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
7193 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
7194 input_section, info, rel,
7195 addend, howto, local_syms,
7196 local_sections, &value,
7197 &name, &require_jalx,
7198 use_saved_addend_p))
7200 case bfd_reloc_continue:
7201 /* There's nothing to do. */
7202 continue;
7204 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
7205 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
7206 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
7207 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
7208 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
7209 continue;
7211 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
7212 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
7213 info->callbacks->warning
7214 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7215 return FALSE;
7217 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
7218 if (use_saved_addend_p)
7219 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
7220 a given location. */
7222 else
7224 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
7225 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
7226 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
7227 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
7228 return FALSE;
7230 break;
7232 case bfd_reloc_ok:
7233 break;
7235 default:
7236 abort ();
7237 break;
7240 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
7241 until we reach the last one. */
7242 if (use_saved_addend_p)
7244 addend = value;
7245 continue;
7248 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7249 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7250 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
7251 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
7252 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
7253 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
7254 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
7255 only a 32-bit VMA. */
7257 bfd_vma sign_bits;
7258 bfd_vma low_bits;
7259 bfd_vma high_bits;
7261 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7262 #ifdef BFD64
7263 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7264 #else
7265 sign_bits = -1;
7266 #endif
7267 else
7268 sign_bits = 0;
7270 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7271 do two separate stores. */
7272 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7274 /* Undo what we did above. */
7275 rel->r_offset -= 4;
7276 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7277 first. */
7278 low_bits = sign_bits;
7279 high_bits = value;
7281 else
7283 low_bits = value;
7284 high_bits = sign_bits;
7286 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7287 contents + rel->r_offset);
7288 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7289 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7290 continue;
7293 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
7294 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
7295 input_bfd, input_section,
7296 contents, require_jalx))
7297 return FALSE;
7300 return TRUE;
7303 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
7304 adjust it appropriately now. */
7306 static void
7307 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7308 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
7310 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
7311 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
7312 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
7313 "_ftext",
7314 "_etext",
7315 "__dso_displacement",
7316 "__elf_header",
7317 "__program_header_table",
7318 NULL
7321 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
7322 "_fdata",
7323 "_edata",
7324 "_end",
7325 "_fbss",
7326 NULL
7329 const char* const *p;
7330 int i;
7332 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
7333 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
7335 ++p)
7336 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
7338 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
7339 IRIX6 linker. */
7340 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7341 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
7343 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
7344 if (i == 0)
7345 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
7346 else
7347 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
7349 break;
7353 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
7354 dynamic sections here. */
7356 bfd_boolean
7357 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
7358 struct bfd_link_info *info,
7359 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
7360 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
7362 bfd *dynobj;
7363 asection *sgot;
7364 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
7365 const char *name;
7367 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7369 if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
7371 asection *s;
7372 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE];
7374 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
7376 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
7378 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
7379 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
7380 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7382 /* FIXME: Can h->dynindex be more than 64K? */
7383 if (h->dynindx & 0xffff0000)
7384 return FALSE;
7386 /* Fill the stub. */
7387 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub);
7388 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + 4);
7389 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + 8);
7390 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16 (output_bfd) + h->dynindx, stub + 12);
7392 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->size);
7393 memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7395 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
7396 only for the referenced symbol. */
7397 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7399 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
7400 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
7401 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
7402 sym->st_value = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
7403 + h->plt.offset);
7406 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
7407 || h->forced_local);
7409 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7410 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
7411 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
7412 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
7413 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
7415 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
7416 the symbols that need them. */
7417 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
7418 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
7420 bfd_vma offset;
7421 bfd_vma value;
7423 value = sym->st_value;
7424 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h, R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
7425 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
7428 if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1 && h->type != STT_TLS)
7430 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
7431 bfd_vma entry;
7432 bfd_vma offset;
7434 gg = g;
7436 e.abfd = output_bfd;
7437 e.symndx = -1;
7438 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
7439 e.tls_type = 0;
7441 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7443 if (g->got_entries
7444 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
7445 &e)))
7447 offset = p->gotidx;
7448 if (info->shared
7449 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
7450 && p->d.h != NULL
7451 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
7452 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
7454 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
7455 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
7456 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
7457 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
7458 appropriate addend. */
7459 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
7461 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
7462 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
7463 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
7464 else
7465 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
7466 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
7468 entry = 0;
7469 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
7470 (output_bfd, info, rel,
7471 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
7472 return FALSE;
7474 else
7475 entry = sym->st_value;
7476 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
7481 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
7482 name = h->root.root.string;
7483 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
7484 || strcmp (name, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
7485 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7486 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
7487 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
7489 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7490 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7491 sym->st_value = 1;
7493 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7495 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7496 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7497 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
7499 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
7501 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
7502 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
7504 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7505 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
7506 sym->st_value = 0;
7507 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
7509 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
7511 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7512 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
7513 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
7514 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7516 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
7518 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
7519 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
7520 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
7521 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
7525 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
7526 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
7527 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
7529 if (! info->shared)
7531 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7532 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
7533 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
7535 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
7536 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7537 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
7538 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
7539 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
7540 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
7542 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7543 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
7545 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
7546 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
7547 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
7548 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
7549 != NULL);
7550 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
7554 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
7555 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
7556 sym->st_value &= ~1;
7558 return TRUE;
7561 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
7563 bfd_boolean
7564 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7565 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7567 bfd *dynobj;
7568 asection *sdyn;
7569 asection *sgot;
7570 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
7572 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7574 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
7576 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7577 if (sgot == NULL)
7578 gg = g = NULL;
7579 else
7581 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
7582 gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
7583 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
7584 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
7585 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
7588 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7590 bfd_byte *b;
7592 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
7593 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
7595 for (b = sdyn->contents;
7596 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
7597 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
7599 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
7600 const char *name;
7601 size_t elemsize;
7602 asection *s;
7603 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
7605 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
7606 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
7608 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
7609 swap_out_p = TRUE;
7611 switch (dyn.d_tag)
7613 case DT_RELENT:
7614 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7615 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7616 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
7617 break;
7619 case DT_STRSZ:
7620 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
7621 dyn.d_un.d_val =
7622 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
7623 break;
7625 case DT_PLTGOT:
7626 name = ".got";
7627 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
7628 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7629 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
7630 break;
7632 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
7633 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
7634 break;
7636 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
7637 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
7638 break;
7640 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
7642 time_t t;
7643 time (&t);
7644 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
7646 break;
7648 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
7649 /* XXX FIXME: */
7650 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7651 break;
7653 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
7654 /* XXX FIXME: */
7655 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7656 break;
7658 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
7659 s = output_bfd->sections;
7660 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7661 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
7662 break;
7664 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
7665 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
7666 break;
7668 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
7669 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
7670 entry of the first external symbol that is not
7671 referenced within the same object. */
7672 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
7673 break;
7675 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
7676 if (gg->global_gotsym)
7678 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
7679 break;
7681 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
7682 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
7683 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
7685 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
7686 name = ".dynsym";
7687 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
7688 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
7689 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7691 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
7692 break;
7694 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
7695 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
7696 break;
7698 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
7699 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
7700 break;
7702 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
7703 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
7704 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
7705 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
7706 break;
7708 default:
7709 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7710 break;
7713 if (swap_out_p)
7714 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
7715 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
7719 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
7720 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
7721 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
7722 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0)
7724 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents);
7725 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000,
7726 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7729 if (sgot != NULL)
7730 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
7731 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7733 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
7734 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
7736 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
7737 bfd_vma addend = 0;
7739 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
7740 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
7742 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7744 bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
7745 + g->next->tls_gotno;
7747 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
7748 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7749 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
7750 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7752 if (! info->shared)
7753 continue;
7755 while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
7757 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
7758 = index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7759 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
7760 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
7761 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
7762 0, &addend, sgot)))
7763 return FALSE;
7764 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
7769 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
7770 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
7771 here. */
7773 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7775 bfd_byte *b;
7776 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
7778 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
7780 for (b = sdyn->contents;
7781 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
7782 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
7784 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
7785 asection *s;
7787 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
7788 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
7790 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
7791 swap_out_p = TRUE;
7793 switch (dyn.d_tag)
7795 case DT_RELSZ:
7796 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
7797 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
7798 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
7799 are trailing null entries. */
7800 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7801 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
7802 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
7803 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
7804 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
7805 break;
7807 default:
7808 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7809 break;
7812 if (swap_out_p)
7813 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
7814 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
7819 asection *s;
7820 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
7822 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
7824 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
7825 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
7826 if (s != NULL)
7828 cpt.id1 = 1;
7829 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
7830 cpt.id2 = 2;
7831 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
7832 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
7833 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
7834 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
7835 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
7836 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
7837 s->contents));
7839 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
7840 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
7841 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
7842 if (s != NULL)
7844 file_ptr dummy_offset;
7846 BFD_ASSERT (s->size >= MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7847 dummy_offset = s->size - MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
7848 memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
7849 MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7854 /* We need to sort the entries of the dynamic relocation section. */
7856 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7858 if (s != NULL
7859 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
7861 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
7863 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
7864 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
7865 sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
7866 else
7867 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
7868 sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs);
7872 return TRUE;
7876 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
7878 static void
7879 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
7881 flagword val;
7883 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
7885 default:
7886 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
7887 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
7888 break;
7890 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
7891 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
7892 break;
7894 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
7895 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
7896 break;
7898 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
7899 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
7900 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
7901 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
7902 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
7903 break;
7905 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
7906 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
7907 break;
7909 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
7910 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
7911 break;
7913 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
7914 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
7915 break;
7917 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
7918 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
7919 break;
7921 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
7922 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
7923 break;
7925 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
7926 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
7927 break;
7929 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
7930 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
7931 break;
7933 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
7934 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
7935 break;
7937 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
7938 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
7939 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
7940 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
7941 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
7942 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
7943 break;
7945 case bfd_mach_mips5:
7946 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
7947 break;
7949 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
7950 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
7951 break;
7953 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
7954 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
7955 break;
7957 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
7958 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
7959 break;
7961 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
7962 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
7963 break;
7965 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
7966 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
7967 break;
7969 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
7970 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
7975 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
7976 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
7977 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
7979 void
7980 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
7981 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7983 unsigned int i;
7984 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
7985 const char *name;
7986 asection *sec;
7988 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
7989 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
7990 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
7991 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
7992 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
7994 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
7995 info for each special section. */
7996 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
7997 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
7998 i++, hdrpp++)
8000 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
8002 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
8003 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
8004 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
8005 if (sec != NULL)
8006 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8007 break;
8009 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
8010 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
8011 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
8012 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
8013 && strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0);
8014 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
8015 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
8016 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8017 break;
8019 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
8020 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
8021 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
8022 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
8023 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content",
8024 sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) == 0);
8025 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8026 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
8027 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
8028 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8029 break;
8031 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
8032 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
8033 if (sec != NULL)
8034 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8035 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
8036 if (sec != NULL)
8037 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8038 break;
8040 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
8041 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
8042 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
8043 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
8044 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0)
8045 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8046 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
8047 else
8049 BFD_ASSERT (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
8050 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0);
8051 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8052 (name
8053 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
8055 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
8056 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8057 break;
8063 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
8064 segments. */
8067 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd)
8069 asection *s;
8070 int ret = 0;
8072 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
8073 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
8074 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
8075 ++ret;
8077 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
8078 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
8079 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8080 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
8081 ++ret;
8083 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
8084 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
8085 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
8086 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
8087 ++ret;
8089 return ret;
8092 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
8094 bfd_boolean
8095 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
8096 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8098 asection *s;
8099 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
8100 bfd_size_type amt;
8102 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
8103 segment. */
8104 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
8105 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
8107 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
8108 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
8109 break;
8110 if (m == NULL)
8112 amt = sizeof *m;
8113 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8114 if (m == NULL)
8115 return FALSE;
8117 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
8118 m->count = 1;
8119 m->sections[0] = s;
8121 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
8122 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
8123 while (*pm != NULL
8124 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
8125 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
8126 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8128 m->next = *pm;
8129 *pm = m;
8133 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
8134 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
8135 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
8136 table. */
8137 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
8138 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
8139 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
8140 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
8141 now. */
8142 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
8144 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
8145 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
8146 break;
8148 if (s)
8150 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
8152 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
8153 while (*pm != NULL
8154 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
8155 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
8156 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8158 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
8159 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8160 options_segment->next = *pm;
8161 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
8162 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
8163 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
8164 options_segment->count = 1;
8165 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
8166 *pm = options_segment;
8169 else
8171 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
8173 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
8174 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
8175 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
8176 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
8177 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
8179 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
8180 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
8181 break;
8182 if (m == NULL)
8184 amt = sizeof *m;
8185 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8186 if (m == NULL)
8187 return FALSE;
8189 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
8191 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
8192 if (s == NULL)
8194 m->count = 0;
8195 m->p_flags = 0;
8196 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
8198 else
8200 m->count = 1;
8201 m->sections[0] = s;
8204 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
8205 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
8206 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
8207 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8208 if (*pm != NULL)
8209 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8211 m->next = *pm;
8212 *pm = m;
8216 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
8217 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
8218 between. */
8219 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
8220 pm = &(*pm)->next)
8221 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
8222 break;
8223 m = *pm;
8224 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
8226 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
8227 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
8228 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
8229 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
8230 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
8232 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
8233 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
8236 if (m != NULL
8237 && m->count == 1 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
8239 static const char *sec_names[] =
8241 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
8243 bfd_vma low, high;
8244 unsigned int i, c;
8245 struct elf_segment_map *n;
8247 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
8248 high = 0;
8249 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
8251 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
8252 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
8254 bfd_size_type sz;
8256 if (low > s->vma)
8257 low = s->vma;
8258 sz = s->size;
8259 if (high < s->vma + sz)
8260 high = s->vma + sz;
8264 c = 0;
8265 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8266 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
8267 && s->vma >= low
8268 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
8269 ++c;
8271 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
8272 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8273 if (n == NULL)
8274 return FALSE;
8275 *n = *m;
8276 n->count = c;
8278 i = 0;
8279 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8281 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
8282 && s->vma >= low
8283 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
8285 n->sections[i] = s;
8286 ++i;
8290 *pm = n;
8294 return TRUE;
8297 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
8298 relocation. */
8300 asection *
8301 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
8302 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8303 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
8304 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8305 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8307 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
8309 if (h != NULL)
8311 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
8313 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
8314 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
8315 break;
8317 default:
8318 switch (h->root.type)
8320 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
8321 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
8322 return h->root.u.def.section;
8324 case bfd_link_hash_common:
8325 return h->root.u.c.p->section;
8327 default:
8328 break;
8332 else
8333 return bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
8335 return NULL;
8338 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
8340 bfd_boolean
8341 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8342 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8343 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8344 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8346 #if 0
8347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8348 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
8349 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
8350 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
8351 unsigned long r_symndx;
8352 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8354 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8355 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
8356 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
8358 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
8359 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
8360 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
8362 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
8363 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8364 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8365 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8366 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8367 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8368 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8369 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8370 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
8371 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
8372 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
8373 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
8374 break;
8376 default:
8377 break;
8379 #endif
8381 return TRUE;
8384 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
8385 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
8386 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
8387 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
8389 void
8390 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (const struct elf_backend_data *bed,
8391 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
8392 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
8394 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
8396 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (bed, dir, ind);
8398 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
8399 return;
8401 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
8402 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
8403 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
8404 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
8405 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
8406 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
8407 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
8409 if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
8410 dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
8411 else
8412 BFD_ASSERT (indmips->tls_type == 0);
8415 void
8416 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
8417 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
8418 bfd_boolean force_local)
8420 bfd *dynobj;
8421 asection *got;
8422 struct mips_got_info *g;
8423 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8425 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
8426 if (h->forced_local)
8427 return;
8428 h->forced_local = force_local;
8430 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8431 if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS
8432 && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE)) != NULL
8433 && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL)
8435 if (g->next)
8437 struct mips_got_entry e;
8438 struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
8440 /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
8441 local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
8442 that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease
8443 the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
8444 the upper limit of global entries. */
8445 e.abfd = dynobj;
8446 e.symndx = -1;
8447 e.d.h = h;
8448 e.tls_type = 0;
8450 for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
8451 if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
8453 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
8454 g->local_gotno++;
8455 g->global_gotno--;
8458 /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
8459 no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry
8460 at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
8461 of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */
8462 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
8464 BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
8465 gg->assigned_gotno--;
8468 else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
8469 /* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
8470 number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
8471 global. */
8472 g->local_gotno++;
8473 else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
8475 /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
8476 been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
8477 instead. */
8478 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
8479 g->local_gotno++;
8480 g->global_gotno--;
8484 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
8487 #define PDR_SIZE 32
8489 bfd_boolean
8490 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
8491 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8493 asection *o;
8494 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8495 unsigned char *tdata;
8496 size_t i, skip;
8498 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
8499 if (! o)
8500 return FALSE;
8501 if (o->size == 0)
8502 return FALSE;
8503 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
8504 return FALSE;
8505 if (o->output_section != NULL
8506 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
8507 return FALSE;
8509 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
8510 if (! tdata)
8511 return FALSE;
8513 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
8514 info->keep_memory);
8515 if (!cookie->rels)
8517 free (tdata);
8518 return FALSE;
8521 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
8522 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
8524 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
8526 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
8528 tdata[i] = 1;
8529 skip ++;
8533 if (skip != 0)
8535 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
8536 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
8537 ret = TRUE;
8539 else
8540 free (tdata);
8542 if (! info->keep_memory)
8543 free (cookie->rels);
8545 return ret;
8548 bfd_boolean
8549 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
8551 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
8552 return TRUE;
8553 return FALSE;
8556 bfd_boolean
8557 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd, asection *sec,
8558 bfd_byte *contents)
8560 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
8561 int i;
8563 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
8564 return FALSE;
8566 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
8567 return FALSE;
8569 to = contents;
8570 end = contents + sec->size;
8571 for (from = contents, i = 0;
8572 from < end;
8573 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
8575 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
8576 continue;
8577 if (to != from)
8578 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
8579 to += PDR_SIZE;
8581 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
8582 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
8583 return TRUE;
8586 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
8587 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
8589 struct mips_elf_find_line
8591 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
8592 struct ecoff_find_line i;
8595 bfd_boolean
8596 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
8597 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
8598 const char **filename_ptr,
8599 const char **functionname_ptr,
8600 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8602 asection *msec;
8604 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
8605 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8606 line_ptr))
8607 return TRUE;
8609 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
8610 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8611 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
8612 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
8613 return TRUE;
8615 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
8616 if (msec != NULL)
8618 flagword origflags;
8619 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
8620 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
8621 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
8623 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
8624 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
8625 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
8626 origflags = msec->flags;
8627 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
8628 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8630 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
8631 if (fi == NULL)
8633 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
8634 char *fraw_src;
8635 char *fraw_end;
8636 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
8637 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
8639 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8640 if (fi == NULL)
8642 msec->flags = origflags;
8643 return FALSE;
8646 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
8648 msec->flags = origflags;
8649 return FALSE;
8652 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
8653 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
8654 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8655 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
8657 msec->flags = origflags;
8658 return FALSE;
8660 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
8661 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
8662 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
8663 fraw_end = (fraw_src
8664 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
8665 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
8666 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
8668 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
8670 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
8671 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
8672 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
8673 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
8674 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
8675 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
8678 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
8679 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8680 line_ptr))
8682 msec->flags = origflags;
8683 return TRUE;
8686 msec->flags = origflags;
8689 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
8691 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
8692 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8693 line_ptr);
8696 bfd_boolean
8697 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8698 const char **filename_ptr,
8699 const char **functionname_ptr,
8700 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8702 bfd_boolean found;
8703 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8704 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8705 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8706 return found;
8710 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
8711 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
8712 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
8714 bfd_boolean
8715 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
8716 const void *location,
8717 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
8719 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
8721 bfd_byte *c;
8723 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
8725 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
8726 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8727 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
8728 return FALSE;
8730 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
8731 if (c == NULL)
8733 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
8734 if (c == NULL)
8735 return FALSE;
8736 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
8739 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
8742 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
8743 count);
8746 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
8747 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
8749 bfd_byte *
8750 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
8751 (bfd *abfd,
8752 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8753 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
8754 bfd_byte *data,
8755 bfd_boolean relocatable,
8756 asymbol **symbols)
8758 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
8759 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
8760 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
8761 bfd_size_type sz;
8763 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
8764 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
8765 long reloc_count;
8767 if (reloc_size < 0)
8768 goto error_return;
8770 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
8771 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
8772 goto error_return;
8774 /* read in the section */
8775 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
8776 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
8777 goto error_return;
8779 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
8780 input_section,
8781 reloc_vector,
8782 symbols);
8783 if (reloc_count < 0)
8784 goto error_return;
8786 if (reloc_count > 0)
8788 arelent **parent;
8789 /* for mips */
8790 int gp_found;
8791 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
8794 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
8795 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
8796 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
8797 if (abfd && input_bfd
8798 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
8799 lh = 0;
8800 else
8802 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
8803 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
8805 lookup:
8806 if (lh)
8808 switch (lh->type)
8810 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
8811 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
8812 case bfd_link_hash_common:
8813 gp_found = 0;
8814 break;
8815 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
8816 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
8817 gp_found = 1;
8818 gp = lh->u.def.value;
8819 break;
8820 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
8821 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
8822 lh = lh->u.i.link;
8823 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
8824 goto lookup;
8825 case bfd_link_hash_new:
8826 default:
8827 abort ();
8830 else
8831 gp_found = 0;
8833 /* end mips */
8834 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
8836 char *error_message = NULL;
8837 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
8839 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
8840 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
8841 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
8843 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
8844 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
8845 to the generic handling. */
8846 if (gp_found
8847 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
8848 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
8849 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
8850 input_section, relocatable,
8851 data, gp);
8852 else
8853 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
8854 input_section,
8855 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
8856 &error_message);
8858 if (relocatable)
8860 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
8862 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
8863 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
8864 os->reloc_count++;
8867 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
8869 switch (r)
8871 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8872 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
8873 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
8874 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address,
8875 TRUE)))
8876 goto error_return;
8877 break;
8878 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
8879 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
8880 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
8881 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
8882 (*parent)->address)))
8883 goto error_return;
8884 break;
8885 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8886 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8887 (link_info, NULL,
8888 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
8889 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
8890 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
8891 goto error_return;
8892 break;
8893 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
8894 default:
8895 abort ();
8896 break;
8902 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
8903 free (reloc_vector);
8904 return data;
8906 error_return:
8907 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
8908 free (reloc_vector);
8909 return NULL;
8912 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
8914 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
8915 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
8917 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
8918 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
8920 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
8921 if (ret == NULL)
8922 return NULL;
8924 if (! _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
8925 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc))
8927 free (ret);
8928 return NULL;
8931 #if 0
8932 /* We no longer use this. */
8933 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
8934 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
8935 #endif
8936 ret->procedure_count = 0;
8937 ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
8938 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
8939 ret->rld_value = 0;
8940 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
8942 return &ret->root.root;
8945 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
8946 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
8947 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
8949 bfd_boolean
8950 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8952 asection *o;
8953 struct bfd_link_order *p;
8954 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
8955 asection *rtproc_sec;
8956 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
8957 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
8958 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8959 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
8960 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
8961 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
8962 asection *s;
8963 EXTR esym;
8964 unsigned int i;
8965 bfd_size_type amt;
8967 static const char * const secname[] =
8969 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
8970 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
8972 static const int sc[] =
8974 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
8975 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
8978 /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
8979 generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
8980 Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
8981 the sort again. */
8982 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8984 bfd *dynobj;
8985 asection *got;
8986 struct mips_got_info *g;
8987 bfd_size_type dynsecsymcount;
8989 /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
8990 the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section
8991 symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only
8992 adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that
8993 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
8994 section above. */
8996 dynsecsymcount = 0;
8997 if (info->shared)
8999 asection * p;
9001 for (p = abfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
9002 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
9003 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
9004 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (abfd, info, p))
9005 ++ dynsecsymcount;
9008 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, dynsecsymcount + 1))
9009 return FALSE;
9011 /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */
9012 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9013 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
9014 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
9016 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
9017 BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
9018 - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
9019 <= g->global_gotno);
9022 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
9023 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
9025 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
9027 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
9028 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
9029 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
9030 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
9031 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
9032 else if (info->relocatable)
9034 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
9036 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
9037 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
9038 if (o->vma < lo
9039 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
9040 lo = o->vma;
9042 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
9043 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (abfd);
9045 else
9047 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
9048 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
9049 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
9053 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
9054 information. */
9055 reginfo_sec = NULL;
9056 mdebug_sec = NULL;
9057 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
9058 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
9059 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
9061 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
9063 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
9065 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
9066 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
9067 the information together. */
9068 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9070 asection *input_section;
9071 bfd *input_bfd;
9072 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
9073 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
9075 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9077 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9078 continue;
9079 abort ();
9082 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9083 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
9085 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
9086 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
9087 return FALSE;
9089 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
9091 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
9092 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
9093 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
9094 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
9095 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
9097 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
9098 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
9099 finally written out. */
9101 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9102 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9103 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9106 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
9107 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
9109 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
9110 matters, but someday it might). */
9111 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9113 reginfo_sec = o;
9116 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
9118 struct extsym_info einfo;
9119 bfd_vma last;
9121 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
9122 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
9123 the information together. */
9124 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
9125 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
9126 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
9127 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
9128 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
9129 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
9130 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
9131 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
9132 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
9133 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
9134 symhdr->issMax = 0;
9135 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
9136 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
9137 symhdr->crfd = 0;
9138 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
9140 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
9141 debug_info structure. */
9142 debug.line = NULL;
9143 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
9144 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
9145 debug.external_sym = NULL;
9146 debug.external_opt = NULL;
9147 debug.external_aux = NULL;
9148 debug.ss = NULL;
9149 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
9150 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
9151 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
9152 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
9154 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
9155 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
9156 return FALSE;
9158 esym.jmptbl = 0;
9159 esym.cobol_main = 0;
9160 esym.weakext = 0;
9161 esym.reserved = 0;
9162 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
9163 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
9164 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
9165 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
9166 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
9167 last = 0;
9168 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
9170 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
9171 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
9172 if (s != NULL)
9174 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
9175 last = s->vma + s->size;
9177 else
9178 esym.asym.value = last;
9179 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
9180 secname[i], &esym))
9181 return FALSE;
9184 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9186 asection *input_section;
9187 bfd *input_bfd;
9188 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
9189 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
9190 char *eraw_src;
9191 char *eraw_end;
9193 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9195 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9196 continue;
9197 abort ();
9200 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9201 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
9203 if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
9204 || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
9205 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
9207 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
9208 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
9209 want to deal with it. */
9210 continue;
9213 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
9214 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
9216 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
9218 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
9219 read in the debugging information and set up an
9220 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
9221 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
9222 &input_debug))
9223 return FALSE;
9225 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
9226 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
9227 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
9228 return FALSE;
9230 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
9231 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
9232 the linker global hash table and save the information
9233 for the output external symbols. */
9234 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
9235 eraw_end = (eraw_src
9236 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
9237 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
9238 for (;
9239 eraw_src < eraw_end;
9240 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
9242 EXTR ext;
9243 const char *name;
9244 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9246 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
9247 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
9248 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
9249 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
9250 continue;
9252 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
9253 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
9254 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
9255 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
9256 continue;
9258 if (ext.ifd != -1)
9260 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
9261 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
9262 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
9265 h->esym = ext;
9268 /* Free up the information we just read. */
9269 free (input_debug.line);
9270 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
9271 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
9272 free (input_debug.external_sym);
9273 free (input_debug.external_opt);
9274 free (input_debug.external_aux);
9275 free (input_debug.ss);
9276 free (input_debug.ssext);
9277 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
9278 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
9279 free (input_debug.external_ext);
9281 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9282 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9283 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9286 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
9288 /* Create .rtproc section. */
9289 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9290 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
9292 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
9293 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
9295 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
9296 ".rtproc",
9297 flags);
9298 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
9299 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
9300 return FALSE;
9303 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
9304 info, rtproc_sec,
9305 &debug))
9306 return FALSE;
9309 /* Build the external symbol information. */
9310 einfo.abfd = abfd;
9311 einfo.info = info;
9312 einfo.debug = &debug;
9313 einfo.swap = swap;
9314 einfo.failed = FALSE;
9315 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
9316 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
9317 if (einfo.failed)
9318 return FALSE;
9320 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
9321 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
9323 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
9324 matters, but someday it might). */
9325 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9327 mdebug_sec = o;
9330 if (strncmp (o->name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
9332 const char *subname;
9333 unsigned int c;
9334 Elf32_gptab *tab;
9335 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
9336 unsigned int j;
9338 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
9339 information describing how the small data area would
9340 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
9341 not used in executables files. */
9342 if (! info->relocatable)
9344 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9346 asection *input_section;
9348 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9350 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9351 continue;
9352 abort ();
9355 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9357 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9358 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9359 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9362 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
9363 currently matters, but someday it might). */
9364 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9366 /* Really remove the section. */
9367 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
9368 --abfd->section_count;
9370 continue;
9373 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
9374 uninitialized data. */
9375 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
9376 gptab_data_sec = o;
9377 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
9378 gptab_bss_sec = o;
9379 else
9381 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9382 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
9383 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
9384 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
9385 return FALSE;
9388 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
9389 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
9390 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
9391 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
9392 case we must change the name of the output section. */
9393 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
9394 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
9396 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
9397 o->name = ".gptab.data";
9398 else
9399 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
9400 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
9401 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
9404 /* Set up the first entry. */
9405 c = 1;
9406 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
9407 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
9408 if (tab == NULL)
9409 return FALSE;
9410 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
9411 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
9413 /* Combine the input sections. */
9414 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9416 asection *input_section;
9417 bfd *input_bfd;
9418 bfd_size_type size;
9419 unsigned long last;
9420 bfd_size_type gpentry;
9422 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9424 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9425 continue;
9426 abort ();
9429 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9430 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
9432 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
9433 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
9434 sorted by ascending -G value. */
9435 size = input_section->size;
9436 last = 0;
9437 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
9438 gpentry < size;
9439 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
9441 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
9442 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
9443 unsigned long val;
9444 unsigned long add;
9445 bfd_boolean exact;
9446 unsigned int look;
9448 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
9449 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
9450 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
9452 free (tab);
9453 return FALSE;
9456 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
9457 &int_gptab);
9458 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
9459 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
9461 exact = FALSE;
9462 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
9464 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
9465 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
9467 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
9468 exact = TRUE;
9471 if (! exact)
9473 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
9474 unsigned int max;
9476 /* We need a new table entry. */
9477 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
9478 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
9479 if (new_tab == NULL)
9481 free (tab);
9482 return FALSE;
9484 tab = new_tab;
9485 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
9486 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
9488 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
9489 value, since that will be implied by this new
9490 value. */
9491 max = 0;
9492 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
9494 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
9495 && (max == 0
9496 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
9497 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
9498 max = look;
9500 if (max != 0)
9501 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
9502 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
9504 ++c;
9507 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
9510 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9511 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9512 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9515 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
9516 if (c > 2)
9517 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
9519 /* Swap out the table. */
9520 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
9521 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
9522 if (ext_tab == NULL)
9524 free (tab);
9525 return FALSE;
9528 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
9529 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
9530 free (tab);
9532 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
9533 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
9535 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
9536 matters, but someday it might). */
9537 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9541 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
9542 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
9543 return FALSE;
9545 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
9547 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
9549 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
9551 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
9552 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
9553 return FALSE;
9556 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
9558 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
9559 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
9560 swap, info,
9561 mdebug_sec->filepos))
9562 return FALSE;
9564 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
9567 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
9569 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
9570 gptab_data_sec->contents,
9571 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
9572 return FALSE;
9575 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
9577 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
9578 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
9579 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
9580 return FALSE;
9583 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
9585 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9586 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
9588 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
9589 rtproc_sec->contents,
9590 0, rtproc_sec->size))
9591 return FALSE;
9595 return TRUE;
9598 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
9600 struct mips_mach_extension {
9601 unsigned long extension, base;
9605 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
9606 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
9608 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
9609 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
9610 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
9611 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
9613 /* MIPS V extensions. */
9614 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
9616 /* R10000 extensions. */
9617 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
9619 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
9620 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
9621 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
9622 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
9623 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
9624 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
9625 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
9627 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
9628 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9629 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9630 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9631 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9632 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9634 /* VR4100 extensions. */
9635 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
9636 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
9638 /* MIPS III extensions. */
9639 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9640 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9641 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9642 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9643 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9644 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9645 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9647 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
9648 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
9650 /* MIPS II extensions. */
9651 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
9652 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
9654 /* MIPS I extensions. */
9655 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
9656 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
9660 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
9662 static bfd_boolean
9663 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
9665 size_t i;
9667 if (extension == base)
9668 return TRUE;
9670 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
9671 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
9672 return TRUE;
9674 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
9675 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
9676 return TRUE;
9678 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
9679 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
9681 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
9682 if (extension == base)
9683 return TRUE;
9686 return FALSE;
9690 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
9692 static bfd_boolean
9693 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
9695 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
9696 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
9697 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
9698 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
9699 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
9700 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
9701 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
9705 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
9706 object file when linking. */
9708 bfd_boolean
9709 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
9711 flagword old_flags;
9712 flagword new_flags;
9713 bfd_boolean ok;
9714 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
9715 asection *sec;
9717 /* Check if we have the same endianess */
9718 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
9720 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9721 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
9722 ibfd);
9723 return FALSE;
9726 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
9727 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9728 return TRUE;
9730 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
9732 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9733 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
9734 ibfd);
9735 return FALSE;
9738 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
9739 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9740 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
9742 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
9744 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
9745 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
9746 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9747 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
9749 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
9750 && bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
9752 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
9753 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
9754 return FALSE;
9757 return TRUE;
9760 /* Check flag compatibility. */
9762 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9763 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9765 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
9766 doesn't seem to matter. */
9767 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
9768 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
9770 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
9771 just be able to ignore this. */
9772 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
9773 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
9775 if (new_flags == old_flags)
9776 return TRUE;
9778 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
9779 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
9780 actually cause any incompatibility. */
9781 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9783 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
9784 which are automatically generated by gas. */
9785 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
9786 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
9787 && (sec->size != 0
9788 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
9789 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
9790 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
9792 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
9793 break;
9796 if (null_input_bfd)
9797 return TRUE;
9799 ok = TRUE;
9801 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
9802 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
9804 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9805 (_("%B: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
9806 ibfd);
9807 ok = TRUE;
9810 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
9811 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
9812 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
9813 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
9815 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
9816 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
9818 /* Compare the ISAs. */
9819 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
9821 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9822 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
9823 ibfd);
9824 ok = FALSE;
9826 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
9828 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
9829 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
9831 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
9832 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
9833 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
9834 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
9835 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9836 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
9837 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9839 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
9840 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
9841 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
9842 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
9843 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
9844 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
9846 else
9848 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
9849 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9850 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
9851 ibfd,
9852 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
9853 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
9854 ok = FALSE;
9858 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9859 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9861 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
9862 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
9863 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
9864 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9865 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
9867 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
9868 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
9869 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9870 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
9872 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9873 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
9874 ibfd,
9875 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
9876 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
9877 ok = FALSE;
9879 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
9880 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
9883 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
9884 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
9886 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9888 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9889 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9892 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
9893 if (new_flags != old_flags)
9895 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9896 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
9897 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
9898 (unsigned long) old_flags);
9899 ok = FALSE;
9902 if (! ok)
9904 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9905 return FALSE;
9908 return TRUE;
9911 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
9913 bfd_boolean
9914 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
9916 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
9917 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
9919 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
9920 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
9921 return TRUE;
9924 bfd_boolean
9925 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
9927 FILE *file = ptr;
9929 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
9931 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
9932 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
9934 /* xgettext:c-format */
9935 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
9937 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
9938 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
9939 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
9940 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
9941 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
9942 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
9943 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
9944 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
9945 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
9946 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
9947 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
9948 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
9949 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
9950 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
9951 else
9952 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
9954 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
9955 fprintf (file, _(" [mips1]"));
9956 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
9957 fprintf (file, _(" [mips2]"));
9958 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
9959 fprintf (file, _(" [mips3]"));
9960 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
9961 fprintf (file, _(" [mips4]"));
9962 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
9963 fprintf (file, _(" [mips5]"));
9964 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
9965 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32]"));
9966 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
9967 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64]"));
9968 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
9969 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32r2]"));
9970 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
9971 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64r2]"));
9972 else
9973 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
9975 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
9976 fprintf (file, _(" [mdmx]"));
9978 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
9979 fprintf (file, _(" [mips16]"));
9981 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
9982 fprintf (file, _(" [32bitmode]"));
9983 else
9984 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
9986 fputc ('\n', file);
9988 return TRUE;
9991 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
9993 { ".lit4", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9994 { ".lit8", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9995 { ".mdebug", 7, 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
9996 { ".sbss", 5, -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9997 { ".sdata", 6, -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9998 { ".ucode", 6, 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
9999 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }